1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H 2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H 3 /* 4 * 802.11 netlink interface public header 5 * 6 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 7 * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net> 8 * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com> 9 * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch> 10 * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com> 11 * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com> 12 * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com> 13 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 14 * Copyright (C) 2018 Intel Corporation 15 * 16 * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any 17 * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above 18 * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. 19 * 20 * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES 21 * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF 22 * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR 23 * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES 24 * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN 25 * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF 26 * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. 27 * 28 */ 29 30 /* 31 * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please 32 * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so 33 * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI. 34 * 35 * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in 36 * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there 37 * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are 38 * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API 39 * can actually be identified and removed. 40 * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file. 41 */ 42 43 #include <linux/types.h> 44 45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211" 46 47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG "config" 48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN "scan" 49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG "regulatory" 50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME "mlme" 51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR "vendor" 52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN "nan" 53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE "testmode" 54 55 /** 56 * DOC: Station handling 57 * 58 * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN 59 * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved 60 * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN). 61 * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added 62 * to. 63 * 64 * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's 65 * capabilities. 66 * 67 * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS 68 * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows: 69 * - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate 70 * or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions 71 * - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid 72 * to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same 73 * time mark it authorized. 74 * - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used 75 * - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down 76 * the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK) 77 * 78 * TODO: need more info for other interface types 79 */ 80 81 /** 82 * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support 83 * 84 * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace 85 * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames 86 * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example, 87 * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel 88 * for various reasons. 89 * 90 * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations 91 * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to 92 * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a 93 * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those 94 * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the 95 * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility 96 * for doing that. 97 * 98 * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the 99 * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy 100 * attributes so applications know what to expect. 101 * 102 * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active, 103 * these registrations are ignored until the interface type is 104 * changed again. This means that changing the interface type can 105 * lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but 106 * any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they 107 * will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames. 108 * 109 * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required 110 * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking, 111 * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its 112 * status is indicated to the sending socket. 113 * 114 * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions 115 * below. 116 */ 117 118 /** 119 * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities 120 * 121 * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have 122 * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this 123 * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions 124 * on the types of concurrency that are supported. 125 * 126 * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in 127 * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the 128 * types there no concurrency is implied. 129 * 130 * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed: 131 * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in 132 * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's 133 * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and 134 * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN 135 * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list 136 * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute. 137 * 138 * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is 139 * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically, 140 * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the 141 * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of 142 * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions 143 * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported 144 * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially 145 * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs. 146 * 147 * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual 148 * interfaces that a given device supports. 149 */ 150 151 /** 152 * DOC: packet coalesce support 153 * 154 * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast 155 * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the 156 * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing 157 * and power consumption. 158 * 159 * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts 160 * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some 161 * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the 162 * following events occur. 163 * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum 164 * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule. 165 * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches it's limit. 166 * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules. 167 * 168 * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce 169 * rule. 170 * a) Maximum coalescing delay 171 * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched 172 * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match' 173 * Multiple such rules can be created. 174 */ 175 176 /** 177 * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload 178 * 179 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers 180 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2 181 * preshared key authentication. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the preshared 182 * key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers supporting 183 * this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no preshared 184 * key material is provided, for example when that driver does not 185 * support setting the temporal keys through %CMD_NEW_KEY. 186 * 187 * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be 188 * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL 189 * handshakes during 802.1X authentication. In order to use the offload 190 * the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS 191 * attribute flag. Drivers supporting this offload may reject the 192 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is not present. 193 * 194 * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK 195 * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also 196 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided. 197 */ 198 199 /** 200 * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload 201 * 202 * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by 203 * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support 204 * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the 205 * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and 206 * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional 207 * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in 208 * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS. 209 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai 210 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai 211 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message 212 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK 213 * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and 214 * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA. 215 * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used 216 * as specified in IETF RFC 6696. 217 * 218 * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the 219 * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting 220 * up a connection or after roaming. 221 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal 222 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges 223 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated 224 * %Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace 225 * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used 226 * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also. 227 * 228 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS 229 * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the 230 * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and 231 * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based 232 * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with 233 * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to 234 * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching. 235 */ 236 237 /** 238 * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands 239 * 240 * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors 241 * 242 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request 243 * to get a list of all present wiphys. 244 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or 245 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME, 246 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ (and the 247 * attributes determining the channel width; this is used for setting 248 * monitor mode channel), %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, 249 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, 250 * and/or %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD. 251 * However, for setting the channel, see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL 252 * instead, the support here is for backward compatibility only. 253 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request 254 * or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and 255 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME. 256 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes 257 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME. 258 * 259 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration; 260 * either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a 261 * single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported. 262 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires 263 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE. 264 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response 265 * to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX, 266 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also 267 * be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface, 268 * then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and 269 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME. 270 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes 271 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from 272 * userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires 273 * attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 274 * 275 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified 276 * by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 277 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT, 278 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD. 279 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA, 280 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER, 281 * and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. 282 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX 283 * or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 284 * 285 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used) 286 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface 287 * using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL 288 * attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses 289 * internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE, 290 * %NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP. 291 * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters 292 * are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that 293 * do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL, 294 * %NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 295 * %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE, 296 * %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS, 297 * %NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY, 298 * %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT, 299 * %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS. 300 * The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the 301 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel width. 302 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP 303 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface 304 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP 305 * 306 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by 307 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 308 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by 309 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 310 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the 311 * the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 312 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 313 * or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified 314 * by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and 315 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type 316 * of disconnection indication should be sent to the station 317 * (Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that 318 * frame). 319 * 320 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to 321 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 322 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 323 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH: Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to 324 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 325 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 326 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by 327 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP. 328 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by 329 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 330 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the 331 * the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 332 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 333 * or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified 334 * by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 335 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by 336 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 337 * 338 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set 339 * regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device 340 * has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the 341 * global regdomain will be returned. 342 * A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the 343 * regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel 344 * information will still be mended according to further hints from 345 * the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API 346 * is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as 347 * all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it). 348 * If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then 349 * its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory 350 * core is not used to help with compliance in this case. 351 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command 352 * after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory 353 * domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our 354 * current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides 355 * NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each 356 * regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes given by 357 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and 358 * %NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by 359 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and 360 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP. 361 * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain 362 * to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will 363 * store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it. 364 * 365 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the 366 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX 367 * 368 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the 369 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX 370 * 371 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The 372 * interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management 373 * frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be 374 * added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with 375 * %NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be 376 * added to all specified management frames generated by 377 * kernel/firmware/driver. 378 * Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this 379 * point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this 380 * command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the 381 * option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN, 382 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE, 383 * NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE. 384 * 385 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results 386 * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters 387 * %NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the 388 * probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to 389 * specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will 390 * be used. 391 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to 392 * NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group) 393 * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons, 394 * partial scan results may be available 395 * 396 * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain 397 * intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by 398 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is 399 * not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified, 400 * scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval. 401 * These attributes are mutually exculsive, 402 * i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if 403 * NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined. 404 * If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan 405 * plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet). 406 * Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS) 407 * are passed, they are used in the probe requests. For 408 * broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty 409 * string). If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and 410 * a passive scan is performed. %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES, 411 * if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not 412 * passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain 413 * are used. Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by 414 * using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute. The first cycle of the 415 * scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY 416 * is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled 417 * scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute 418 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it. 419 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if 420 * scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon 421 * as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again. 422 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan 423 * results available. 424 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has 425 * stopped. The driver may issue this event at any time during a 426 * scheduled scan. One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware 427 * does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running 428 * a scheduled scan. This event is also sent when the 429 * %NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface 430 * is brought down while a scheduled scan was running. 431 * 432 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation 433 * or noise level 434 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to 435 * NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group) 436 * 437 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 438 * (for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK 439 * (PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or 440 * using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, 441 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS 442 * authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier 443 * advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an 444 * ESS. 445 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 446 * (for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 447 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS 448 * authentication. 449 * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries. 450 * 451 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain 452 * has been changed and provides details of the request information 453 * that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request 454 * (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx 455 * (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if 456 * the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or 457 * %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain 458 * set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is 459 * %NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on 460 * to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2). 461 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon 462 * has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or 463 * any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel 464 * where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example 465 * if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your 466 * driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while 467 * doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not 468 * on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP 469 * or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will 470 * never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always 471 * enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had 472 * either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to 473 * userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from 474 * (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred 475 * before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER) 476 * the beacon hint was processed. 477 * 478 * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification. 479 * This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and 480 * as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the 481 * authentication process. 482 * When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the 483 * interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and 484 * BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify 485 * the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication 486 * request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used 487 * to specify the frequence of the channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE 488 * is used to specify the authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to 489 * define IEs (VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) 490 * to be added to the frame. 491 * When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication 492 * frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the 493 * frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct 494 * state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the 495 * MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The 496 * included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame 497 * (including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is 498 * also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that 499 * case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a 500 * %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which 501 * pending authentication timed out). 502 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like 503 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation 504 * (similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request, 505 * MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The 506 * %NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the 507 * request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not 508 * included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is 509 * included). 510 * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like 511 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to 512 * MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication 513 * primitives). 514 * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like 515 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to 516 * MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives). 517 * 518 * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael 519 * MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the 520 * event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of 521 * the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key 522 * type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and 523 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this 524 * event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive 525 * 526 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a 527 * FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found) 528 * and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those 529 * should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be 530 * executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ 531 * may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval, 532 * given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not 533 * given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms). 534 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is 535 * determined by the network interface. 536 * 537 * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute 538 * to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through 539 * to the driver. 540 * 541 * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command 542 * requests to connect to a specified network but without separating 543 * auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a 544 * %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association 545 * IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, 546 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT, 547 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 548 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT, 549 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and 550 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT. 551 * If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are 552 * restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming 553 * within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT 554 * can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while 555 * allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to 556 * ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one 557 * set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing 558 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict 559 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT). 560 * %NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within 561 * the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with 562 * a different BSS is desired. 563 * Background scan period can optionally be 564 * specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD, 565 * if not specified default background scan configuration 566 * in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled. 567 * This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan. 568 * It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the 569 * connection is established or failed to be established. This can be 570 * determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success, 571 * non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the 572 * event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate 573 * authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP. 574 * Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as 575 * well to remain backwards compatible. 576 * When establishing a security association, drivers that support 4 way 577 * handshake offload should send %NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event when 578 * the 4 way handshake is completed successfully. 579 * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself. 580 * When a security association was established with the new AP (e.g. if 581 * the FT protocol was used for roaming or the driver completed the 4 way 582 * handshake), this event should be followed by an 583 * %NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event. 584 * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify 585 * userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other 586 * reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and 587 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used. 588 * 589 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices 590 * associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow. 591 * 592 * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified 593 * channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do 594 * off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for 595 * a response while being associated to an AP on another channel. 596 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus 597 * radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the 598 * frequency for the operation. 599 * %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds 600 * to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to 601 * notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the 602 * driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the 603 * radio). 604 * When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) 605 * that will be included with any events pertaining to this request; 606 * the cookie is also used to cancel the request. 607 * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a 608 * pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been 609 * completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration. 610 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the 611 * radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to 612 * uniquely identify the request. 613 * This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested 614 * remain-on-channel duration has expired. 615 * 616 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX 617 * rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface 618 * and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates. 619 * 620 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames 621 * (via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command 622 * requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for 623 * backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames) 624 * and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame 625 * that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or 626 * four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration 627 * cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink 628 * socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made. 629 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for 630 * backward compatibility 631 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This 632 * command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and 633 * as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in 634 * kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a 635 * user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the 636 * frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used 637 * to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was 638 * received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel 639 * or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel 640 * and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time 641 * specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation 642 * returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the 643 * TX status event pertaining to the TX request. 644 * %NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the 645 * management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band. 646 * %NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA 647 * counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute 648 * is used during CSA period. 649 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this 650 * command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait 651 * time if it is known that it is no longer necessary. 652 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility. 653 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame 654 * transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies 655 * the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the 656 * frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged 657 * the frame. 658 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for 659 * backward compatibility. 660 * 661 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE 662 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE 663 * 664 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command 665 * is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger 666 * levels. 667 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This 668 * command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was 669 * reached. 670 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 671 * and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface 672 * (identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on. 673 * In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism 674 * with which it switches channels is implementation-defined. 675 * When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while 676 * no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation 677 * of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take 678 * precedence when they are used. 679 * 680 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface. 681 * 682 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform 683 * multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets 684 * with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header) 685 * will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast) 686 * MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may 687 * break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop 688 * unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability 689 * to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases. 690 * This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of 691 * type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces 692 * (%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode. 693 * If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this 694 * command, the feature is disabled. 695 * 696 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial 697 * mesh config parameters may be given. 698 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the 699 * network is determined by the network interface. 700 * 701 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame 702 * notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected 703 * deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use. 704 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame 705 * notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected 706 * disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use. 707 * 708 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a 709 * beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer. This is only 710 * sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer 711 * candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH, 712 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or 713 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set. On reception of this 714 * notification, userspace may decide to create a new station 715 * (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). To stop this notification from 716 * reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the 717 * new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later 718 * depending on the authentication result. 719 * 720 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings. 721 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings. 722 * Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports 723 * various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this 724 * command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For 725 * more background information, see 726 * http://wireless.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN. 727 * The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification 728 * from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the 729 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason 730 * for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present 731 * in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the 732 * wakeup but reports that it was woken up. 733 * 734 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver 735 * the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This 736 * feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data 737 * is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and 738 * contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened, 739 * this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to 740 * inform userspace of the new replay counter. 741 * 742 * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace 743 * of PMKSA caching dandidates. 744 * 745 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup). 746 * In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take 747 * actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one). 748 * In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested 749 * operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and 750 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with 751 * %NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN). 752 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The 753 * %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be 754 * sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as 755 * 802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012 756 * 8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently 757 * supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES 758 * and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in 759 * &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode. 760 * 761 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP 762 * (or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to 763 * implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3 764 * frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame 765 * is received. 766 * For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and 767 * other attributes like the interface index are present. 768 * If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can 769 * only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription 770 * is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events. 771 * 772 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the 773 * associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame 774 * and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly 775 * to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener. 776 * 777 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface 778 * by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is 779 * acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses 780 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a 781 * direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match 782 * up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and 783 * has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed. 784 * 785 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from 786 * other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement 787 * OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME 788 * messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register. 789 * 790 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether 791 * No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied. 792 * 793 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels 794 * independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating 795 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the 796 * attributes determining channel width. This indication may also be 797 * sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA 798 * from the remote AP) is completed; 799 * 800 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch 801 * has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator 802 * (ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or 803 * initiated on our own). It indicates that 804 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 805 * after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's. The userspace may 806 * decide to react to this indication by requesting other 807 * interfaces to change channel as well. 808 * 809 * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by 810 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with 811 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the 812 * P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and 813 * public action frame TX. 814 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by 815 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. 816 * 817 * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to 818 * notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a 819 * station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON 820 * is used for this. 821 * 822 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames 823 * for IBSS or MESH vif. 824 * 825 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control. 826 * This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC 827 * address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in 828 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in 829 * %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it 830 * is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver 831 * will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This 832 * command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its 833 * ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP. 834 * 835 * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once 836 * a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished 837 * or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with 838 * this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars 839 * while operating on this channel. 840 * %NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the 841 * event. 842 * 843 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features, 844 * i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features. 845 * Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap. 846 * 847 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition 848 * Information Element to the WLAN driver 849 * 850 * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver 851 * to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along 852 * with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report 853 * received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE). 854 * 855 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running 856 * a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to 857 * complete. 858 * 859 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can 860 * return back to normal. 861 * 862 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules. 863 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules. 864 * 865 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the 866 * the new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA) 867 * in the beacon for some time (as defined in the 868 * %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the 869 * new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using 870 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel 871 * width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform 872 * other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel 873 * switch is complete. 874 * 875 * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified 876 * by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in 877 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in 878 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 879 * For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is 880 * used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions 881 * (&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands. 882 * This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes. 883 * 884 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values. 885 * The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If 886 * that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this 887 * QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an 888 * association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart. 889 * 890 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given 891 * %NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO 892 * and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters. 893 * Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by 894 * userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets 895 * up the TX TS in the driver/device. 896 * If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks 897 * if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to 898 * avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would 899 * make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still 900 * fail even if the check was successful. 901 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID 902 * and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this 903 * before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating 904 * or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case. 905 * 906 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to 907 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 908 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 909 * 910 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and 911 * bandwidth of a channel must be given. 912 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the 913 * network is determined by the network interface. 914 * 915 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer, 916 * identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is 917 * provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining 918 * channel width/type. The target operating class is given via 919 * %NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS. 920 * The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching 921 * operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the 922 * AP. 923 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS 924 * peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel 925 * when this command completes. 926 * 927 * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used 928 * as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom 929 * management. 930 * 931 * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is 932 * not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through 933 * cfg80211_scan_done(). 934 * 935 * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its 936 * %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been 937 * previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it 938 * has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a 939 * cluster. This command must have a valid 940 * %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional 941 * %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes. If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is 942 * omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will 943 * decide what to use. After this command NAN functions can be 944 * added. 945 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by 946 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. 947 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined 948 * with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this 949 * operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id 950 * (%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) 951 * of the function upon success. 952 * Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right 953 * way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination 954 * event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new 955 * function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one 956 * which just terminated. 957 * This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command 958 * returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes 959 * the response to this command. 960 * Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well. 961 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie. 962 * This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is 963 * terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID 964 * and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes. 965 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN 966 * configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN 967 * was executed). It must contain at least one of the following 968 * attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF, 969 * %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS. If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the 970 * current configuration is not changed. If it is present but 971 * set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care 972 * (i.e. the device can decide what to do). 973 * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported. 974 * This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and 975 * %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE. 976 * 977 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters 978 * for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal 979 * BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it 980 * does not result in a change for the current association. Currently, 981 * only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command. 982 * 983 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0 984 * for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC). 985 * When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the 986 * PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK. 987 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously 988 * configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by 989 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 990 * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates that the 4 way 991 * handshake was completed successfully by the driver. The BSSID is 992 * specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Drivers that support 4 way handshake 993 * offload should send this event after indicating 802.11 association with 994 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or %NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed 995 * %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT should be indicated instead. 996 * 997 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request 998 * and RX notification. This command is used both as a request to transmit 999 * a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame 1000 * has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the 1001 * frame contents. The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or 1002 * 802.11 headers. 1003 * When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 1004 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added 1005 * indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame 1006 * was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively. 1007 * 1008 * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded. 1009 * 1010 * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host 1011 * drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and 1012 * association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen. 1013 * This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space) 1014 * to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to 1015 * driver) to indicate the authentication status. 1016 * 1017 * User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to 1018 * trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses 1019 * this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user 1020 * space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user 1021 * space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds 1022 * further with the association after getting successful authentication 1023 * status. User space indicates the authentication status through 1024 * %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH 1025 * command interface. 1026 * 1027 * Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the 1028 * user space through the connect result as the user space would have 1029 * initiated the connection through the connect request. 1030 * 1031 * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's 1032 * ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE, 1033 * %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its 1034 * address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC). 1035 * 1036 * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number 1037 * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use 1038 */ 1039 enum nl80211_commands { 1040 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */ 1041 NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC, 1042 1043 NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, /* can dump */ 1044 NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY, 1045 NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY, 1046 NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY, 1047 1048 NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE, /* can dump */ 1049 NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE, 1050 NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE, 1051 NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE, 1052 1053 NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY, 1054 NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY, 1055 NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY, 1056 NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY, 1057 1058 NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON, 1059 NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, 1060 NL80211_CMD_START_AP, 1061 NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP, 1062 NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP, 1063 NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP, 1064 1065 NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, 1066 NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION, 1067 NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, 1068 NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION, 1069 1070 NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, 1071 NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH, 1072 NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH, 1073 NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH, 1074 1075 NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS, 1076 1077 NL80211_CMD_SET_REG, 1078 NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG, 1079 1080 NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG, 1081 NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG, 1082 1083 NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */, 1084 1085 NL80211_CMD_GET_REG, 1086 1087 NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN, 1088 NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN, 1089 NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS, 1090 NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED, 1091 1092 NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, 1093 1094 NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, 1095 NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE, 1096 NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1097 NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, 1098 1099 NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE, 1100 1101 NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT, 1102 1103 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS, 1104 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS, 1105 1106 NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 1107 1108 NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, 1109 NL80211_CMD_ROAM, 1110 NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT, 1111 1112 NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS, 1113 1114 NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, 1115 NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS, 1116 1117 NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA, 1118 NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA, 1119 NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA, 1120 1121 NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL, 1122 NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL, 1123 1124 NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK, 1125 1126 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME, 1127 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME, 1128 NL80211_CMD_FRAME, 1129 NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME, 1130 NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1131 NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1132 1133 NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE, 1134 NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE, 1135 1136 NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM, 1137 NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM, 1138 1139 NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL, 1140 NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER, 1141 1142 NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL, 1143 1144 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH, 1145 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH, 1146 1147 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1148 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE, 1149 1150 NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE, 1151 1152 NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN, 1153 NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN, 1154 1155 NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN, 1156 NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN, 1157 NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS, 1158 NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED, 1159 1160 NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD, 1161 1162 NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 1163 1164 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER, 1165 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT, 1166 1167 NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME, 1168 1169 NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT, 1170 1171 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS, 1172 1173 NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME, 1174 1175 NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP, 1176 1177 NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY, 1178 1179 NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE, 1180 NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE, 1181 1182 NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED, 1183 1184 NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE, 1185 1186 NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, 1187 1188 NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT, 1189 1190 NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES, 1191 1192 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES, 1193 NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT, 1194 1195 NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START, 1196 NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP, 1197 1198 NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE, 1199 NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE, 1200 1201 NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1202 1203 NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 1204 1205 NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP, 1206 1207 NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS, 1208 NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS, 1209 1210 NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP, 1211 1212 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB, 1213 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB, 1214 1215 NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY, 1216 1217 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1218 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1219 1220 NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE, 1221 1222 NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN, 1223 1224 NL80211_CMD_START_NAN, 1225 NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN, 1226 NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION, 1227 NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION, 1228 NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, 1229 NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH, 1230 1231 NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST, 1232 1233 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS, 1234 1235 NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK, 1236 NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK, 1237 1238 NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED, 1239 1240 NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB, 1241 1242 NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH, 1243 1244 NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED, 1245 1246 NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME, 1247 1248 /* add new commands above here */ 1249 1250 /* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */ 1251 __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST, 1252 NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1 1253 }; 1254 1255 /* 1256 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them 1257 * here 1258 */ 1259 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS 1260 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE 1261 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE 1262 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE 1263 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE 1264 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE 1265 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE 1266 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT 1267 1268 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS 1269 1270 /* source-level API compatibility */ 1271 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG 1272 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG 1273 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE 1274 1275 /** 1276 * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes 1277 * 1278 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors 1279 * 1280 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf. 1281 * /sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index 1282 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming) 1283 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters 1284 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz, 1285 * defines the channel together with the (deprecated) 1286 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes 1287 * %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 1288 * and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 1289 * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values 1290 * of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the 1291 * documentation of the enum for more information. 1292 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the 1293 * channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth 1294 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the 1295 * channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth 1296 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 1297 * if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included): 1298 * NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including 1299 * this attribute) 1300 * NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only 1301 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel 1302 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel 1303 * This attribute is now deprecated. 1304 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is 1305 * less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255; 1306 * dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8 1307 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is 1308 * greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255; 1309 * dot11ShortLongLimit; u8 1310 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum 1311 * length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable 1312 * fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32 1313 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length 1314 * larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range: 1315 * 0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32 1316 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11 1317 * section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8 1318 * 1319 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on 1320 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name 1321 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype 1322 * 1323 * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices 1324 * that don't have a netdev (u64) 1325 * 1326 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses) 1327 * 1328 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of 1329 * 16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC 1330 * keys 1331 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3) 1332 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11 1333 * section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04) 1334 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and 1335 * CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian 1336 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key 1337 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the 1338 * default management key 1339 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or 1340 * other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used 1341 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or 1342 * other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used 1343 * 1344 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU 1345 * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing 1346 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE 1347 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE 1348 * 1349 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16) 1350 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of 1351 * &enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2) 1352 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by 1353 * IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16). 1354 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported 1355 * rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length 1356 * restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1357 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station 1358 * to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to to. 1359 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info 1360 * given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing 1361 * info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info. 1362 * 1363 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands, 1364 * consisting of a nested array. 1365 * 1366 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes). 1367 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link 1368 * (see &enum nl80211_plink_action). 1369 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path. 1370 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path 1371 * info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at 1372 * &enum nl80211_mpath_info. 1373 * 1374 * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of 1375 * &enum nl80211_mntr_flags. 1376 * 1377 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the 1378 * current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to. 1379 * For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel 1380 * to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can 1381 * also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set 1382 * regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the 1383 * IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country. 1384 * Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain 1385 * to a specific alpha2. 1386 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory 1387 * rules. 1388 * 1389 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1) 1390 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1391 * (u8, 0 or 1) 1392 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled 1393 * (u8, 0 or 1) 1394 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic 1395 * rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length 1396 * restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1397 * 1398 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from 1399 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 1400 * 1401 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all 1402 * supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number 1403 * of the interface mode. 1404 * 1405 * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for 1406 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE. 1407 * 1408 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with 1409 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE). 1410 * 1411 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with 1412 * a single scan request, a wiphy attribute. 1413 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can 1414 * scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute. 1415 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements 1416 * that can be added to a scan request 1417 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information 1418 * elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request 1419 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be 1420 * used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute. 1421 * 1422 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz) 1423 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive 1424 * scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan 1425 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS 1426 * 1427 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain 1428 * currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_* 1429 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently 1430 * set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*) 1431 * 1432 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies 1433 * an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number) 1434 * that the driver for the given wiphy supports. 1435 * 1436 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header 1437 * and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and 1438 * NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events 1439 * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets) 1440 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type, 1441 * represented as a u32 1442 * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and 1443 * %NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16 1444 * 1445 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as 1446 * a u32 1447 * 1448 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change 1449 * due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects 1450 * the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This 1451 * attributes consists of a nested attribute containing 1452 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_* 1453 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change 1454 * due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects 1455 * the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This 1456 * attributes consists of a nested attribute containing 1457 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_* 1458 * 1459 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported 1460 * cipher suites 1461 * 1462 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look 1463 * for other networks on different channels 1464 * 1465 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this 1466 * is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event 1467 * 1468 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is 1469 * used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32); 1470 * this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 1471 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for 1472 * %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it 1473 * must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not. 1474 * Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will 1475 * let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not. 1476 * 1477 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a 1478 * &struct nl80211_sta_flag_update. 1479 * 1480 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls 1481 * IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in 1482 * station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE 1483 * request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until 1484 * authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by 1485 * default in station mode. 1486 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the 1487 * ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be 1488 * specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not 1489 * specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This 1490 * attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to 1491 * indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported. 1492 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with 1493 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom 1494 * ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted. 1495 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control 1496 * port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE) 1497 * will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211 1498 * socket. If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending 1499 * control port frames directly to the network interface is used. If the 1500 * flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead 1501 * using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME. If control port routing over NL80211 is 1502 * to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER 1503 * flag. 1504 * 1505 * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver. 1506 * We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this. 1507 * 1508 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT 1509 * event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to 1510 * a local disconnect request. 1511 * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 1512 * event (u16) 1513 * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating 1514 * that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to 1515 * indicate that the BSS is to use protection. 1516 * 1517 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON 1518 * to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection 1519 * (an array of u32). 1520 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1521 * indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a 1522 * u32). 1523 * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1524 * indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using 1525 * (a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions). 1526 * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1527 * indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32). 1528 * 1529 * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as 1530 * sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events. 1531 * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as 1532 * sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events. 1533 * 1534 * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT 1535 * commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use 1536 * Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the 1537 * Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is 1538 * used for the initial association to an ESS. 1539 * 1540 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with 1541 * %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes 1542 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect() 1543 * and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each 1544 * with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes 1545 * 1546 * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace. 1547 * 1548 * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for 1549 * dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being 1550 * dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has 1551 * obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that 1552 * all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it 1553 * changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated 1554 * completely from scratch. 1555 * 1556 * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface 1557 * 1558 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of 1559 * the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute 1560 * containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info. 1561 * 1562 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching. 1563 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can 1564 * cache, a wiphy attribute. 1565 * 1566 * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32. 1567 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that 1568 * specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the 1569 * remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32. 1570 * 1571 * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects. 1572 * 1573 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes 1574 * (enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The 1575 * enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested 1576 * data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all 1577 * rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute 1578 * is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP, 1579 * and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must 1580 * specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon. 1581 * The driver must also specify support for this with the extended 1582 * features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY, 1583 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT and 1584 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT. 1585 * 1586 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain 1587 * at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME. 1588 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the 1589 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command. 1590 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a 1591 * nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing 1592 * information about which frame types can be transmitted with 1593 * %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 1594 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a 1595 * nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing 1596 * information about which frame types can be registered for RX. 1597 * 1598 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was 1599 * acknowledged by the recipient. 1600 * 1601 * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values. 1602 * 1603 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a 1604 * nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes. 1605 * 1606 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command 1607 * is requesting a local authentication/association state change without 1608 * invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with 1609 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1610 * NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE. 1611 * 1612 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations 1613 * connected to this BSS. 1614 * 1615 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See 1616 * &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values. 1617 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units. 1618 * This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING 1619 * for non-automatic settings. 1620 * 1621 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly 1622 * means support for per-station GTKs. 1623 * 1624 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting. 1625 * This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should 1626 * not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this 1627 * bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna. 1628 * 1629 * Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first 1630 * bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n 1631 * drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to 1632 * a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if 1633 * a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not. 1634 * HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be 1635 * derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask. 1636 * Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not. 1637 * Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot 1638 * support by returning -EINVAL. 1639 * 1640 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving. 1641 * This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should 1642 * not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap 1643 * the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna. 1644 * For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX. 1645 * 1646 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available 1647 * for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters. 1648 * 1649 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available 1650 * for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters. 1651 * 1652 * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS 1653 * 1654 * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be 1655 * transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match 1656 * the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this 1657 * flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an 1658 * nl80211 capability flag. 1659 * 1660 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16) 1661 * 1662 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags 1663 * attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as. 1664 * See &enum nl80211_key_default_types. 1665 * 1666 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters. These cannot be 1667 * changed once the mesh is active. 1668 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute 1669 * containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params. 1670 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver 1671 * allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via 1672 * the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag. 1673 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in 1674 * &enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link 1675 * management state machine. @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or 1676 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled. 1677 * 1678 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy 1679 * capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers 1680 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to 1681 * indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also 1682 * used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN 1683 * triggers. 1684 * 1685 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan 1686 * cycles, in msecs. 1687 * 1688 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more 1689 * sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans. Only BSSs 1690 * that match any of the sets will be reported. These are 1691 * pass-thru filter rules. 1692 * For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a 1693 * set. Since not every hardware supports matching all types of 1694 * attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are 1695 * fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be 1696 * able to ignore them by itself. 1697 * Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but 1698 * this is only an optimization and the userspace application 1699 * needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway. 1700 * If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with 1701 * the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID 1702 * is included in the probe request, but the match attributes 1703 * will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned. 1704 * If ommited, no filtering is done. 1705 * 1706 * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported 1707 * interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes 1708 * defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs. 1709 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like 1710 * %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that 1711 * are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to 1712 * any restrictions in their number or combinations. 1713 * 1714 * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information 1715 * necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data. 1716 * 1717 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan, 1718 * nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry 1719 * being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but 1720 * without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1721 * 1722 * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon 1723 * and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see 1724 * &enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32 1725 * 1726 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame. 1727 * This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to 1728 * provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the 1729 * driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames. 1730 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association 1731 * Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and 1732 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into 1733 * (Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to 1734 * (Re)Association Request frames. 1735 * 1736 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration 1737 * of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr. 1738 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working 1739 * as AP. 1740 * 1741 * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of 1742 * roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low. 1743 * 1744 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching 1745 * candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr. 1746 * 1747 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not 1748 * for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action 1749 * frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space 1750 * applications use this attribute. 1751 * This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and 1752 * %NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands. 1753 * 1754 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup 1755 * request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are 1756 * described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification. 1757 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a 1758 * TDLS conversation between two devices. 1759 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see 1760 * &enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8. 1761 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate 1762 * as a TDLS peer sta. 1763 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown 1764 * procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via 1765 * %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 1766 * used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation. 1767 * 1768 * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices 1769 * that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated 1770 * with support for the features listed in this attribute, see 1771 * &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 1772 * 1773 * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells 1774 * the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this, 1775 * it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is 1776 * mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime. 1777 * 1778 * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from 1779 * &enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information. 1780 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe 1781 * requests while operating in AP-mode. 1782 * This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for 1783 * offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr). 1784 * 1785 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire 1786 * probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out, 1787 * to be filled by the FW. 1788 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable 1789 * this feature. Currently, only supported in mac80211 drivers. 1790 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the 1791 * ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid. 1792 * Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature. 1793 * The values that may be configured are: 1794 * MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40 1795 * AMPDU density and AMPDU factor. 1796 * All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored 1797 * by the driver as required. The actual values may be seen in 1798 * the station debugfs ht_caps file. 1799 * 1800 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country 1801 * abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps 1802 * to one DFS region. 1803 * 1804 * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of 1805 * up to 16 TIDs. 1806 * 1807 * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be 1808 * used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support 1809 * to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the staion entry from 1810 * the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the 1811 * capability to timeout the stations. 1812 * 1813 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int); 1814 * this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to 1815 * received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 1816 * 1817 * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds 1818 * or 0 to disable background scan. 1819 * 1820 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from 1821 * userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from 1822 * a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source 1823 * was used to provide the hint. For the different types of 1824 * allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type. 1825 * 1826 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected 1827 * the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason 1828 * enum has different reasons of connection failure. 1829 * 1830 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. 1831 * This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), 1832 * excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the 1833 * Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with 1834 * authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into 1835 * the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the 1836 * initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and 1837 * Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data 1838 * for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition 1839 * consistent. 1840 * 1841 * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from 1842 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 1843 * 1844 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32) 1845 * 1846 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with 1847 * the START_AP and SET_BSS commands 1848 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the 1849 * START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1; 1850 * if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS 1851 * no change is made. 1852 * 1853 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode 1854 * defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode. 1855 * 1856 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy, 1857 * carried in a u32 attribute 1858 * 1859 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for 1860 * MAC ACL. 1861 * 1862 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum 1863 * number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC 1864 * ACL. 1865 * 1866 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace, 1867 * contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32). 1868 * 1869 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver 1870 * has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See 1871 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information. 1872 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver 1873 * has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields. 1874 * 1875 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to 1876 * the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD). 1877 * 1878 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are 1879 * advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations 1880 * and PU-APSD. 1881 * 1882 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see 1883 * &enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32. 1884 * 1885 * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports 1886 * receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple 1887 * messages, given with wiphy dump message 1888 * 1889 * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier 1890 * 1891 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information 1892 * Element 1893 * 1894 * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased 1895 * reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16). 1896 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which 1897 * the connection should have increased reliability (u16). 1898 * 1899 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16). 1900 * This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being 1901 * allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to 1902 * update a TDLS peer STA entry. 1903 * 1904 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information. 1905 * 1906 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's 1907 * until the channel switch event. 1908 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission 1909 * must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch 1910 * operation). 1911 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information 1912 * for the time while performing a channel switch. 1913 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel 1914 * switch counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL). 1915 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel 1916 * switch counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP). 1917 * 1918 * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32. 1919 * As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags. 1920 * 1921 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels. 1922 * 1923 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported 1924 * supported operating classes. 1925 * 1926 * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space 1927 * controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in 1928 * %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS 1929 * channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required 1930 * to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the 1931 * IBSS network. 1932 * 1933 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports 1934 * 5 MHz channel bandwidth. 1935 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports 1936 * 10 MHz channel bandwidth. 1937 * 1938 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode 1939 * Notification Element based on association request when used with 1940 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when 1941 * %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS); 1942 * u8 attribute. 1943 * 1944 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if 1945 * %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet) 1946 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command 1947 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this 1948 * attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement 1949 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy 1950 * info, containing a nested array of possible events 1951 * 1952 * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This 1953 * data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element 1954 * in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97. 1955 * 1956 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS 1957 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS 1958 * 1959 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many 1960 * associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32. 1961 * Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g., 1962 * other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to 1963 * advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt 1964 * to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail. 1965 * 1966 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which 1967 * should be updated when the frame is transmitted. 1968 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum 1969 * supported number of csa counters. 1970 * 1971 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32. 1972 * As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability. 1973 * 1974 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface 1975 * creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket 1976 * that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed. 1977 * If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be 1978 * owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will 1979 * be stopped when the socket is closed. 1980 * If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the 1981 * regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket 1982 * that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be 1983 * cleared when the socket is closed. 1984 * If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed 1985 * if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN 1986 * notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this 1987 * attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN 1988 * multicast group. 1989 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the 1990 * station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed. 1991 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically 1992 * torn down when the socket is closed. 1993 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be 1994 * automatically torn down when the socket is closed. 1995 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically 1996 * disabled when the socket is closed. 1997 * 1998 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is 1999 * the TDLS link initiator. 2000 * 2001 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection 2002 * shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be 2003 * used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. 2004 * User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the 2005 * underlying device supports these minimal RRM features: 2006 * %NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES, 2007 * %NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET, 2008 * Or, if global RRM is supported, see: 2009 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM 2010 * If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the 2011 * association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability 2012 * flag in the association request's Capability Info field. 2013 * 2014 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout 2015 * estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack 2016 * %NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower 2017 * drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled 2018 * setting valid value for coverage class. 2019 * 2020 * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute) 2021 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute) 2022 * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds 2023 * (per second) (u16 attribute) 2024 * 2025 * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see 2026 * &enum nl80211_smps_mode. 2027 * 2028 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class 2029 * 2030 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask 2031 * 2032 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device 2033 * is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain 2034 * obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global 2035 * cfg80211 regdomain. 2036 * 2037 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte 2038 * array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum 2039 * nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the 2040 * least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0 2041 * is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1 2042 * of byte 3 (u8 array). 2043 * 2044 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be 2045 * returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY 2046 * may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio 2047 * statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.) 2048 * For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information 2049 * should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters 2050 * over all channels. 2051 * 2052 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a 2053 * scheduled scan is started. Or the delay before a WoWLAN 2054 * net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the 2055 * system is suspended. This value is a u32, in seconds. 2056 2057 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device 2058 * is operating in an indoor environment. 2059 * 2060 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for 2061 * scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2062 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for 2063 * a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2064 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in 2065 * a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2066 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan. 2067 * Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval 2068 * between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely, 2069 * thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval 2070 * between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially. 2071 * Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan. 2072 * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate 2073 * in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request 2074 * connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start 2075 * a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only. 2076 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the 2077 * BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains 2078 * attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what 2079 * BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 2080 * it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for 2081 * BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware. 2082 * 2083 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported 2084 * or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status 2085 * 2086 * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 2087 * 2088 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes: 2089 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA, 2090 * %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities per 2091 * interface type. 2092 * 2093 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO 2094 * groupID for monitor mode. 2095 * The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each 2096 * group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved), 2097 * each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in 2098 * that group and 0 for not being a member. 2099 * The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for 2100 * each group. 2101 * (smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger 2102 * group numbers on least significant bits.) 2103 * This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode. 2104 * Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO 2105 * groupID data. 2106 * to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero. 2107 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow 2108 * when using MU-MIMO air sniffer. 2109 * to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address 2110 * (e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF) 2111 * 2112 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually 2113 * started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that 2114 * requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this 2115 * attribute must not be included). 2116 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which 2117 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set. 2118 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If 2119 * %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the 2120 * maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with 2121 * measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN 2122 * if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement. 2123 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates 2124 * that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is 2125 * mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration 2126 * and the actual measurement duration may be shorter. 2127 * 2128 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is 2129 * used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state. 2130 * 2131 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by 2132 * %NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with 2133 * %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0. 2134 * Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and 2135 * should not be used during a normal device operation. 2136 * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration. This is a u32 2137 * bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum 2138 * nl80211_band. For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 2139 * would be set. This attribute is used with 2140 * %NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and 2141 * it is optional. If no bands are set, it means don't-care and 2142 * the device will decide what to use. 2143 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See 2144 * &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested 2145 * attribute. 2146 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute. 2147 * See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes. 2148 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame 2149 * protection. 2150 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association 2151 * Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet 2152 * STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2153 * 2154 * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast 2155 * packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute). 2156 * 2157 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also 2158 * used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID. 2159 * 2160 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which 2161 * other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current 2162 * connected BSS so that they get reported to user space. 2163 * This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to 2164 * other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than 2165 * the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid 2166 * unnecessary wakeups. 2167 * 2168 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in 2169 * the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 2170 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparision to figure out 2171 * better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure 2172 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 2173 * 2174 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out. 2175 * u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used, 2176 * e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event. 2177 * 2178 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) 2179 * username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with 2180 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2181 * 2182 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part 2183 * of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with 2184 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2185 * 2186 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number 2187 * to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data 2188 * for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2189 * 2190 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the 2191 * NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and 2192 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK 2193 * from successful FILS authentication and is used with 2194 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2195 * 2196 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP 2197 * identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with 2198 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA. 2199 * 2200 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with 2201 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID. 2202 * For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT it is used to provide PSK for offloading 4-way 2203 * handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X authentication it is 2204 * used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support this attribute 2205 * specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is included as well. 2206 * 2207 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to 2208 * indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests. 2209 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled 2210 * scan request that may be active for the device (u32). 2211 * 2212 * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include 2213 * in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it 2214 * wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake. 2215 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT. 2216 * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved) 2217 * 2218 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external 2219 * authentication operation (u32 attribute with an 2220 * &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the 2221 * %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event. 2222 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user 2223 * space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used 2224 * only with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request. The driver may offload 2225 * authentication processing to user space if this capability is indicated 2226 * in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests from the user space. 2227 * 2228 * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated RX_NSS value notified using this 2229 * u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED. 2230 * 2231 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum 2232 * nl80211_txq_stats) 2233 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy. 2234 * The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced. 2235 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory memory limit (in bytes) for the 2236 * TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is 2237 * enforced. 2238 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes 2239 * a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler. 2240 * 2241 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available 2242 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined 2243 * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 2244 */ 2245 enum nl80211_attrs { 2246 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */ 2247 NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC, 2248 2249 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, 2250 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME, 2251 2252 NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX, 2253 NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME, 2254 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, 2255 2256 NL80211_ATTR_MAC, 2257 2258 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA, 2259 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, 2260 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER, 2261 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ, 2262 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT, 2263 2264 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL, 2265 NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, 2266 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD, 2267 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL, 2268 2269 NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID, 2270 NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS, 2271 NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL, 2272 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES, 2273 NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN, 2274 NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO, 2275 2276 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS, 2277 2278 NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS, 2279 2280 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID, 2281 NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION, 2282 NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP, 2283 NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO, 2284 2285 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT, 2286 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 2287 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME, 2288 2289 NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY, 2290 2291 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES, 2292 2293 NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2, 2294 NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES, 2295 2296 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG, 2297 2298 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES, 2299 2300 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, 2301 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 2302 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE, 2303 2304 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, 2305 2306 NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE, 2307 NL80211_ATTR_IE, 2308 2309 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS, 2310 2311 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES, 2312 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS, 2313 NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */ 2314 NL80211_ATTR_BSS, 2315 2316 NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR, 2317 NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE, 2318 2319 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS, 2320 2321 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME, 2322 NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 2323 NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, 2324 NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE, 2325 2326 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE, 2327 2328 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN, 2329 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES, 2330 2331 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE, 2332 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER, 2333 2334 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED, 2335 2336 2337 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, 2338 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, 2339 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, 2340 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD, 2341 2342 NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT, 2343 2344 NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, 2345 2346 NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2, 2347 2348 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT, 2349 2350 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 2351 2352 NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY, 2353 2354 NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP, 2355 NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE, 2356 2357 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE, 2358 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP, 2359 NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS, 2360 NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, 2361 2362 NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE, 2363 NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE, 2364 2365 NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID, 2366 2367 NL80211_ATTR_KEY, 2368 NL80211_ATTR_KEYS, 2369 2370 NL80211_ATTR_PID, 2371 2372 NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR, 2373 2374 NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO, 2375 2376 NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, 2377 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS, 2378 2379 NL80211_ATTR_DURATION, 2380 2381 NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE, 2382 2383 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS, 2384 2385 NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES, 2386 2387 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH, 2388 2389 NL80211_ATTR_ACK, 2390 2391 NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE, 2392 2393 NL80211_ATTR_CQM, 2394 2395 NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE, 2396 2397 NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE, 2398 2399 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING, 2400 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL, 2401 2402 NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES, 2403 NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES, 2404 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE, 2405 2406 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 2407 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT, 2408 2409 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN, 2410 2411 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX, 2412 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX, 2413 2414 NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE, 2415 2416 NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK, 2417 2418 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE, 2419 2420 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES, 2421 2422 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION, 2423 2424 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP, 2425 2426 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX, 2427 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX, 2428 2429 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH, 2430 NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE, 2431 2432 NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS, 2433 NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, 2434 2435 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL, 2436 2437 NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS, 2438 NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES, 2439 2440 NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA, 2441 2442 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS, 2443 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN, 2444 2445 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES, 2446 2447 NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, 2448 2449 NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP, 2450 NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP, 2451 2452 NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME, 2453 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD, 2454 2455 NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT, 2456 2457 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, 2458 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS, 2459 2460 NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 2461 2462 NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE, 2463 2464 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION, 2465 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN, 2466 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION, 2467 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT, 2468 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP, 2469 2470 NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME, 2471 2472 NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK, 2473 2474 NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS, 2475 2476 NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD, 2477 2478 NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP, 2479 2480 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION, 2481 2482 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT, 2483 NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK, 2484 2485 NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP, 2486 2487 NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT, 2488 2489 NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM, 2490 2491 NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD, 2492 2493 NL80211_ATTR_WDEV, 2494 2495 NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE, 2496 2497 NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON, 2498 2499 NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA, 2500 2501 NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY, 2502 2503 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS, 2504 2505 NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH, 2506 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1, 2507 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2, 2508 2509 NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW, 2510 NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS, 2511 2512 NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE, 2513 2514 NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY, 2515 2516 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS, 2517 2518 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX, 2519 2520 NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT, 2521 2522 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA, 2523 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, 2524 2525 NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY, 2526 NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY, 2527 2528 NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES, 2529 NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP, 2530 2531 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT, 2532 NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK, 2533 2534 NL80211_ATTR_MDID, 2535 NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC, 2536 2537 NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID, 2538 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION, 2539 2540 NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID, 2541 2542 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE, 2543 2544 NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT, 2545 NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX, 2546 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES, 2547 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON, 2548 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP, 2549 2550 NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS, 2551 2552 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS, 2553 2554 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES, 2555 2556 NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS, 2557 2558 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ, 2559 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ, 2560 2561 NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF, 2562 2563 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID, 2564 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD, 2565 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 2566 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS, 2567 2568 NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP, 2569 2570 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, 2571 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT, 2572 2573 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA, 2574 2575 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY, 2576 2577 NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER, 2578 2579 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX, 2580 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS, 2581 2582 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR, 2583 2584 NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM, 2585 2586 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK, 2587 2588 NL80211_ATTR_TSID, 2589 NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO, 2590 NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME, 2591 2592 NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE, 2593 2594 NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS, 2595 2596 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK, 2597 2598 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG, 2599 2600 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES, 2601 2602 NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS, 2603 2604 NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD, 2605 2606 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY, 2607 2608 NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR, 2609 2610 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS, 2611 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL, 2612 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS, 2613 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS, 2614 2615 NL80211_ATTR_PBSS, 2616 2617 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT, 2618 2619 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS, 2620 2621 NL80211_ATTR_PAD, 2622 2623 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA, 2624 2625 NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA, 2626 NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR, 2627 2628 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF, 2629 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID, 2630 NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION, 2631 NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY, 2632 2633 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID, 2634 2635 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF, 2636 NL80211_ATTR_BANDS, 2637 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC, 2638 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH, 2639 2640 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK, 2641 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES, 2642 2643 NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED, 2644 2645 NL80211_ATTR_BSSID, 2646 2647 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI, 2648 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST, 2649 2650 NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON, 2651 2652 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME, 2653 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM, 2654 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM, 2655 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK, 2656 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, 2657 2658 NL80211_ATTR_PMK, 2659 2660 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI, 2661 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS, 2662 2663 NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS, 2664 NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME, 2665 NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED, 2666 2667 NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION, 2668 NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT, 2669 2670 NL80211_ATTR_NSS, 2671 NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL, 2672 2673 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, 2674 2675 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS, 2676 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT, 2677 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT, 2678 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM, 2679 2680 /* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */ 2681 2682 __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 2683 NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 2684 NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 2685 }; 2686 2687 /* source-level API compatibility */ 2688 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION 2689 #define NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG 2690 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER 2691 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA 2692 2693 /* 2694 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them 2695 * here 2696 */ 2697 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 2698 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY 2699 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES 2700 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS 2701 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 2702 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE 2703 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE 2704 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE 2705 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR 2706 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE 2707 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME 2708 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID 2709 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE 2710 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE 2711 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE 2712 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP 2713 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS 2714 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES 2715 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY 2716 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS 2717 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS 2718 2719 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN 64 2720 2721 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES 32 2722 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES 77 2723 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES 64 2724 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY 0 2725 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY 16 2726 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY 24 2727 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN 26 2728 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN 12 2729 2730 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES 5 2731 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES 2 2732 2733 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME 10 2734 2735 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */ 2736 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF -300 2737 2738 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL 1800 2739 2740 /** 2741 * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types 2742 * 2743 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides 2744 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member 2745 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member 2746 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point 2747 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces 2748 * are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing 2749 * AP type interface. 2750 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface 2751 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames 2752 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point 2753 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client 2754 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner 2755 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev 2756 * and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the 2757 * %NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE 2758 * commands to create and destroy one 2759 * @NL80211_IF_TYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS 2760 * This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true 2761 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev) 2762 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined 2763 * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types 2764 * 2765 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE 2766 * to set the type of an interface. 2767 * 2768 */ 2769 enum nl80211_iftype { 2770 NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED, 2771 NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC, 2772 NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION, 2773 NL80211_IFTYPE_AP, 2774 NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN, 2775 NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS, 2776 NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR, 2777 NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT, 2778 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT, 2779 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO, 2780 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE, 2781 NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB, 2782 NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN, 2783 2784 /* keep last */ 2785 NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES, 2786 NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1 2787 }; 2788 2789 /** 2790 * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags 2791 * 2792 * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is 2793 * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.) 2794 * 2795 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 2796 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 2797 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames 2798 * with short barker preamble 2799 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable 2800 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection 2801 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated 2802 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should 2803 * only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the 2804 * flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and 2805 * attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected 2806 * as errors.) 2807 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers 2808 * that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a 2809 * previously added station into associated state 2810 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined 2811 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use 2812 */ 2813 enum nl80211_sta_flags { 2814 __NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID, 2815 NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, 2816 NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 2817 NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME, 2818 NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP, 2819 NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED, 2820 NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER, 2821 NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED, 2822 2823 /* keep last */ 2824 __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST, 2825 NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1 2826 }; 2827 2828 /** 2829 * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS 2830 * 2831 * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism 2832 * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism 2833 * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values 2834 */ 2835 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status { 2836 NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0, 2837 NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED, 2838 2839 NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS, 2840 }; 2841 2842 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER 2843 2844 /** 2845 * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set 2846 * @mask: mask of station flags to set 2847 * @set: which values to set them to 2848 * 2849 * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags. 2850 */ 2851 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update { 2852 __u32 mask; 2853 __u32 set; 2854 } __attribute__((packed)); 2855 2856 /** 2857 * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information 2858 * 2859 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE 2860 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station. 2861 * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents 2862 * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value. 2863 * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported 2864 * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits 2865 * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included. 2866 * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall 2867 * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels. 2868 * 2869 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 2870 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s) 2871 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8) 2872 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate 2873 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 2874 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s) 2875 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined 2876 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8) 2877 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8) 2878 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate 2879 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the 2880 * same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates 2881 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate 2882 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is 2883 * a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e. 2884 * half the base (20 MHz) rate 2885 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is 2886 * a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e. 2887 * a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate 2888 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 2889 */ 2890 enum nl80211_rate_info { 2891 __NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID, 2892 NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE, 2893 NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS, 2894 NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH, 2895 NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI, 2896 NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32, 2897 NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS, 2898 NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS, 2899 NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH, 2900 NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH, 2901 NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH, 2902 NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH, 2903 NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH, 2904 2905 /* keep last */ 2906 __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 2907 NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 2908 }; 2909 2910 /** 2911 * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA 2912 * 2913 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM 2914 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station. 2915 * 2916 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 2917 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag) 2918 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 2919 * (flag) 2920 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 2921 * (flag) 2922 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8) 2923 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16) 2924 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined 2925 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use 2926 */ 2927 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param { 2928 __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID, 2929 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT, 2930 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 2931 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME, 2932 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD, 2933 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL, 2934 2935 /* keep last */ 2936 __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST, 2937 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1 2938 }; 2939 2940 /** 2941 * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information 2942 * 2943 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO 2944 * when getting information about a station. 2945 * 2946 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 2947 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs) 2948 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length) 2949 * (u32, from this station) 2950 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length) 2951 * (u32, to this station) 2952 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length) 2953 * (u64, from this station) 2954 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length) 2955 * (u64, to this station) 2956 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm) 2957 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute 2958 * containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info 2959 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs) 2960 * (u32, from this station) 2961 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs) 2962 * (u32, to this station) 2963 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station) 2964 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs) 2965 * (u32, to this station) 2966 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm) 2967 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID 2968 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID 2969 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station 2970 * (see %enum nl80211_plink_state) 2971 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested 2972 * attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE. 2973 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute 2974 * containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param 2975 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected 2976 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update. 2977 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32) 2978 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64) 2979 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode 2980 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode 2981 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards 2982 * non-peer STA 2983 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU 2984 * Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm) 2985 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average 2986 * Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL. 2987 * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the 2988 * 802.11 header (u32, kbps) 2989 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons 2990 * (u64) 2991 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64) 2992 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average 2993 * for beacons only (u8, dBm) 2994 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats) 2995 * This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the 2996 * TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames; 2997 * each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats 2998 * attributes carrying the actual values. 2999 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames 3000 * received from the station (u64, usec) 3001 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3002 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm) 3003 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of (data) 3004 * ACK frame (s8, dBm) 3005 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal 3006 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute 3007 */ 3008 enum nl80211_sta_info { 3009 __NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID, 3010 NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME, 3011 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES, 3012 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES, 3013 NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID, 3014 NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID, 3015 NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE, 3016 NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL, 3017 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE, 3018 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS, 3019 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS, 3020 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES, 3021 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED, 3022 NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG, 3023 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE, 3024 NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM, 3025 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME, 3026 NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS, 3027 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS, 3028 NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET, 3029 NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM, 3030 NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM, 3031 NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM, 3032 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64, 3033 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64, 3034 NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL, 3035 NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG, 3036 NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT, 3037 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC, 3038 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX, 3039 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG, 3040 NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS, 3041 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION, 3042 NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD, 3043 NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL, 3044 NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG, 3045 3046 /* keep last */ 3047 __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3048 NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3049 }; 3050 3051 /** 3052 * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes 3053 * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3054 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64) 3055 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or 3056 * attempted to transmit; u64) 3057 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for 3058 * transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64) 3059 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted 3060 * MSDUs (u64) 3061 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3062 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute) 3063 * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here 3064 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here 3065 */ 3066 enum nl80211_tid_stats { 3067 __NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID, 3068 NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU, 3069 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU, 3070 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES, 3071 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED, 3072 NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD, 3073 NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS, 3074 3075 /* keep last */ 3076 NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS, 3077 NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1 3078 }; 3079 3080 /** 3081 * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes 3082 * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3083 * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here 3084 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged 3085 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently 3086 * backlogged 3087 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen 3088 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops 3089 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks 3090 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow 3091 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 3092 * (only for per-phy stats) 3093 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions 3094 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ 3095 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ 3096 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY 3097 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here 3098 */ 3099 enum nl80211_txq_stats { 3100 __NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID, 3101 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES, 3102 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS, 3103 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS, 3104 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS, 3105 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS, 3106 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT, 3107 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY, 3108 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS, 3109 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES, 3110 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS, 3111 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS, 3112 3113 /* keep last */ 3114 NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS, 3115 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1 3116 }; 3117 3118 /** 3119 * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags 3120 * 3121 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active 3122 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running 3123 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN 3124 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set 3125 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded 3126 */ 3127 enum nl80211_mpath_flags { 3128 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<0, 3129 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING = 1<<1, 3130 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID = 1<<2, 3131 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED = 1<<3, 3132 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED = 1<<4, 3133 }; 3134 3135 /** 3136 * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information 3137 * 3138 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting 3139 * information about a mesh path. 3140 * 3141 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3142 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination 3143 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number 3144 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path 3145 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now 3146 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in 3147 * &enum nl80211_mpath_flags; 3148 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec 3149 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries 3150 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number 3151 * currently defind 3152 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3153 */ 3154 enum nl80211_mpath_info { 3155 __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID, 3156 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN, 3157 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN, 3158 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC, 3159 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME, 3160 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS, 3161 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT, 3162 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES, 3163 3164 /* keep last */ 3165 __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3166 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3167 }; 3168 3169 /** 3170 * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes 3171 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3172 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band, 3173 * an array of nested frequency attributes 3174 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band, 3175 * an array of nested bitrate attributes 3176 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as 3177 * defined in 802.11n 3178 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE 3179 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n 3180 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n 3181 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as 3182 * defined in 802.11ac 3183 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE 3184 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined 3185 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3186 */ 3187 enum nl80211_band_attr { 3188 __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID, 3189 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS, 3190 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES, 3191 3192 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET, 3193 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA, 3194 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR, 3195 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY, 3196 3197 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET, 3198 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA, 3199 3200 /* keep last */ 3201 __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3202 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3203 }; 3204 3205 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA 3206 3207 /** 3208 * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule 3209 * 3210 * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3211 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot. 3212 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot. 3213 * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space. 3214 * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time. 3215 * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule. 3216 * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use. 3217 */ 3218 enum nl80211_wmm_rule { 3219 __NL80211_WMMR_INVALID, 3220 NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN, 3221 NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX, 3222 NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN, 3223 NL80211_WMMR_TXOP, 3224 3225 /* keep last */ 3226 __NL80211_WMMR_LAST, 3227 NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1 3228 }; 3229 3230 /** 3231 * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes 3232 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3233 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz 3234 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current 3235 * regulatory domain. 3236 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation 3237 * are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe 3238 * requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing. 3239 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory 3240 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 3241 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm 3242 * (100 * dBm). 3243 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS 3244 * (enum nl80211_dfs_state) 3245 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long 3246 * this channel is in this DFS state. 3247 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this 3248 * channel as the control channel 3249 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this 3250 * channel as the control channel 3251 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel 3252 * as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible, 3253 * this includes 80+80 channels 3254 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel 3255 * using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels 3256 * isn't possible 3257 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds. 3258 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this 3259 * channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be 3260 * used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in 3261 * an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not 3262 * through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master 3263 * that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power. 3264 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this 3265 * channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on 3266 * the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz 3267 * band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS 3268 * off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be 3269 * done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under 3270 * the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS 3271 * off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and 3272 * radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e., 3273 * wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this 3274 * attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP). 3275 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed 3276 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 3277 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed 3278 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 3279 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations. 3280 * This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC. 3281 * (see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule) 3282 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number 3283 * currently defined 3284 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3285 * 3286 * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122 3287 * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed 3288 * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and 3289 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT. 3290 */ 3291 enum nl80211_frequency_attr { 3292 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID, 3293 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ, 3294 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED, 3295 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR, 3296 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS, 3297 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR, 3298 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER, 3299 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE, 3300 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME, 3301 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS, 3302 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS, 3303 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ, 3304 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ, 3305 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME, 3306 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY, 3307 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT, 3308 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ, 3309 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ, 3310 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM, 3311 3312 /* keep last */ 3313 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3314 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3315 }; 3316 3317 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER 3318 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 3319 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 3320 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 3321 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \ 3322 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 3323 3324 /** 3325 * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes 3326 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3327 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps 3328 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported 3329 * in 2.4 GHz band. 3330 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number 3331 * currently defined 3332 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3333 */ 3334 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr { 3335 __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID, 3336 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE, 3337 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE, 3338 3339 /* keep last */ 3340 __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3341 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3342 }; 3343 3344 /** 3345 * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request 3346 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world 3347 * regulatory domain. 3348 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the 3349 * regulatory domain. 3350 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the 3351 * wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in. 3352 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an 3353 * 802.11 country information element with regulatory information it 3354 * thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country 3355 * code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information 3356 * structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb. 3357 * If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should 3358 * be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation. 3359 */ 3360 enum nl80211_reg_initiator { 3361 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE, 3362 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER, 3363 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, 3364 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE, 3365 }; 3366 3367 /** 3368 * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain 3369 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains 3370 * to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the 3371 * ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid. 3372 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory 3373 * domain. 3374 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom 3375 * driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide 3376 * and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested 3377 * them to be applied. 3378 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product 3379 * of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously 3380 * set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory 3381 * domain request to be processed. 3382 */ 3383 enum nl80211_reg_type { 3384 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY, 3385 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD, 3386 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD, 3387 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION, 3388 }; 3389 3390 /** 3391 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes 3392 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3393 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional 3394 * considerations for a given frequency range. These are the 3395 * &enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags. 3396 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory 3397 * rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory 3398 * band edge. 3399 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule 3400 * in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory 3401 * band edge. 3402 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this 3403 * frequency range, in KHz. 3404 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain 3405 * for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi). 3406 * If you don't have one then don't send this. 3407 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for 3408 * a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm). 3409 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds. 3410 * If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used. 3411 * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number 3412 * currently defined 3413 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3414 */ 3415 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr { 3416 __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID, 3417 NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, 3418 3419 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START, 3420 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END, 3421 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW, 3422 3423 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN, 3424 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP, 3425 3426 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME, 3427 3428 /* keep last */ 3429 __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3430 NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3431 }; 3432 3433 /** 3434 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes 3435 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3436 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching, 3437 * only report BSS with matching SSID. 3438 * (This cannot be used together with BSSID.) 3439 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a 3440 * BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that 3441 * if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as 3442 * the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a 3443 * matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with 3444 * how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem, 3445 * the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this 3446 * attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute. 3447 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether 3448 * %NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or 3449 * relative to current bss's RSSI. 3450 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for 3451 * BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 3452 * RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure 3453 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 3454 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching 3455 * (this cannot be used together with SSID). 3456 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter 3457 * attribute number currently defined 3458 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3459 */ 3460 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr { 3461 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID, 3462 3463 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID, 3464 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI, 3465 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI, 3466 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST, 3467 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID, 3468 3469 /* keep last */ 3470 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3471 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = 3472 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3473 }; 3474 3475 /* only for backward compatibility */ 3476 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID 3477 3478 /** 3479 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags 3480 * 3481 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed 3482 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed 3483 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed 3484 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed 3485 * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used 3486 * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links 3487 * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links 3488 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed, 3489 * this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require 3490 * beaconing. 3491 * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated 3492 * base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross 3493 * multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges. 3494 * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 3495 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation 3496 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation 3497 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed 3498 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed 3499 */ 3500 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags { 3501 NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM = 1<<0, 3502 NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK = 1<<1, 3503 NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR = 1<<2, 3504 NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR = 1<<3, 3505 NL80211_RRF_DFS = 1<<4, 3506 NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY = 1<<5, 3507 NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY = 1<<6, 3508 NL80211_RRF_NO_IR = 1<<7, 3509 __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS = 1<<8, 3510 NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW = 1<<11, 3511 NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<12, 3512 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<13, 3513 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<14, 3514 NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ = 1<<15, 3515 NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ = 1<<16, 3516 }; 3517 3518 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 3519 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 3520 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 3521 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40 (NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\ 3522 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS) 3523 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT 3524 3525 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */ 3526 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL (NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS) 3527 3528 /** 3529 * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions 3530 * 3531 * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified 3532 * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC 3533 * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI 3534 * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec 3535 */ 3536 enum nl80211_dfs_regions { 3537 NL80211_DFS_UNSET = 0, 3538 NL80211_DFS_FCC = 1, 3539 NL80211_DFS_ETSI = 2, 3540 NL80211_DFS_JP = 3, 3541 }; 3542 3543 /** 3544 * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint 3545 * 3546 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always 3547 * assumed if the attribute is not set. 3548 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular 3549 * base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work 3550 * properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints 3551 * by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature 3552 * capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will 3553 * ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device 3554 * present has been registered with the wireless core that 3555 * has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a 3556 * supported feature. 3557 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the 3558 * platform is operating in an indoor environment. 3559 */ 3560 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type { 3561 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER = 0, 3562 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1, 3563 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR = 2, 3564 }; 3565 3566 /** 3567 * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information 3568 * 3569 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO 3570 * when getting information about a survey. 3571 * 3572 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3573 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel 3574 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm) 3575 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 3576 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio 3577 * was turned on (on channel or globally) 3578 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary 3579 * channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect) 3580 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension 3581 * channel was sensed busy 3582 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent 3583 * receiving data (on channel or globally) 3584 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent 3585 * transmitting data (on channel or globally) 3586 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan 3587 * (on this channel or globally) 3588 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3589 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number 3590 * currently defined 3591 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3592 */ 3593 enum nl80211_survey_info { 3594 __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID, 3595 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY, 3596 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE, 3597 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE, 3598 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME, 3599 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY, 3600 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY, 3601 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX, 3602 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX, 3603 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN, 3604 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD, 3605 3606 /* keep last */ 3607 __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3608 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3609 }; 3610 3611 /* keep old names for compatibility */ 3612 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME 3613 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY 3614 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY 3615 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX 3616 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX 3617 3618 /** 3619 * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags 3620 * 3621 * Monitor configuration flags. 3622 * 3623 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved 3624 * 3625 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 3626 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 3627 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 3628 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 3629 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing. 3630 * overrides all other flags. 3631 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address 3632 * and ACK incoming unicast packets. 3633 * 3634 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3635 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag 3636 */ 3637 enum nl80211_mntr_flags { 3638 __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 3639 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 3640 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 3641 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 3642 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 3643 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 3644 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 3645 3646 /* keep last */ 3647 __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST, 3648 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1 3649 }; 3650 3651 /** 3652 * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes 3653 * 3654 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is 3655 * not known or has not been set yet. 3656 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is 3657 * in Awake state all the time. 3658 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will 3659 * alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for 3660 * neighbor's beacons. 3661 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will 3662 * alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up 3663 * for neighbor's beacons. 3664 * 3665 * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use 3666 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level 3667 */ 3668 3669 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode { 3670 NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN, 3671 NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE, 3672 NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP, 3673 NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP, 3674 3675 __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST, 3676 NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1 3677 }; 3678 3679 /** 3680 * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters 3681 * 3682 * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is 3683 * active. 3684 * 3685 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use 3686 * 3687 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in 3688 * millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message 3689 * 3690 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in 3691 * millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link 3692 * 3693 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in 3694 * millisecond units 3695 * 3696 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed 3697 * on this mesh interface 3698 * 3699 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link 3700 * open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a 3701 * mesh 3702 * 3703 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh 3704 * point. 3705 * 3706 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open 3707 * peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if 3708 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are 3709 * set. 3710 * 3711 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames 3712 * containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path 3713 * target) 3714 * 3715 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths 3716 * (in milliseconds) 3717 * 3718 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait 3719 * until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds) 3720 * 3721 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh 3722 * points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from 3723 * the root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 3724 * 3725 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in 3726 * TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 3727 * reference element 3728 * 3729 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs) 3730 * that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the 3731 * mesh 3732 * 3733 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not 3734 * 3735 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a 3736 * source mesh point for path selection elements. 3737 * 3738 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between 3739 * root announcements are transmitted. 3740 * 3741 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has 3742 * access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. This is done via Root 3743 * Announcement frames. 3744 * 3745 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in 3746 * TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a 3747 * PERR element. 3748 * 3749 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding 3750 * or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 3751 * 3752 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the 3753 * threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish 3754 * a peer link. 3755 * 3756 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors 3757 * to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 3758 * (see 11C.12.2.2) 3759 * 3760 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode. 3761 * 3762 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute 3763 * 3764 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for 3765 * which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding 3766 * information to the root mesh STA to be valid. 3767 * 3768 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between 3769 * proactive PREQs are transmitted. 3770 * 3771 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time 3772 * (in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame 3773 * containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 3774 * 3775 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links. 3776 * type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32) 3777 * 3778 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs) 3779 * 3780 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've 3781 * established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then 3782 * remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable 3783 * the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes. 3784 * 3785 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3786 */ 3787 enum nl80211_meshconf_params { 3788 __NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID, 3789 NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT, 3790 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT, 3791 NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT, 3792 NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS, 3793 NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES, 3794 NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL, 3795 NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS, 3796 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES, 3797 NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME, 3798 NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT, 3799 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT, 3800 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL, 3801 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME, 3802 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE, 3803 NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL, 3804 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL, 3805 NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS, 3806 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL, 3807 NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING, 3808 NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD, 3809 NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR, 3810 NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE, 3811 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT, 3812 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL, 3813 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL, 3814 NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE, 3815 NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW, 3816 NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT, 3817 3818 /* keep last */ 3819 __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3820 NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3821 }; 3822 3823 /** 3824 * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters 3825 * 3826 * Mesh setup parameters. These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be 3827 * changed while the mesh is active. 3828 * 3829 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use 3830 * 3831 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a 3832 * vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the 3833 * default HWMP. 3834 * 3835 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a 3836 * vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime 3837 * metric. 3838 * 3839 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a 3840 * robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element 3841 * that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and 3842 * metrics in use. 3843 * 3844 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication 3845 * daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates. 3846 * 3847 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication 3848 * daemon will be securing peer link frames. AMPE is a secured version of 3849 * Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of 3850 * a userspace daemon. When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer 3851 * management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE 3852 * functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and 3853 * key management). When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can 3854 * autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a 3855 * userspace daemon. 3856 * 3857 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a 3858 * vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default 3859 * neighbor offset synchronization 3860 * 3861 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will 3862 * implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state. 3863 * 3864 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication 3865 * method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE). 3866 * Default is no authentication method required. 3867 * 3868 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number 3869 * 3870 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use 3871 */ 3872 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params { 3873 __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID, 3874 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL, 3875 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC, 3876 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE, 3877 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH, 3878 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, 3879 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC, 3880 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM, 3881 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL, 3882 3883 /* keep last */ 3884 __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3885 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3886 }; 3887 3888 /** 3889 * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes 3890 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved 3891 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*) 3892 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning 3893 * disabled 3894 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 3895 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 3896 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 3897 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 3898 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 3899 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal 3900 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number 3901 */ 3902 enum nl80211_txq_attr { 3903 __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID, 3904 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC, 3905 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP, 3906 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN, 3907 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX, 3908 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS, 3909 3910 /* keep last */ 3911 __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3912 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3913 }; 3914 3915 enum nl80211_ac { 3916 NL80211_AC_VO, 3917 NL80211_AC_VI, 3918 NL80211_AC_BE, 3919 NL80211_AC_BK, 3920 NL80211_NUM_ACS 3921 }; 3922 3923 /* backward compat */ 3924 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC 3925 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO NL80211_AC_VO 3926 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI NL80211_AC_VI 3927 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE NL80211_AC_BE 3928 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK NL80211_AC_BK 3929 3930 /** 3931 * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type 3932 * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel 3933 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel 3934 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel 3935 * below the control channel 3936 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel 3937 * above the control channel 3938 */ 3939 enum nl80211_channel_type { 3940 NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT, 3941 NL80211_CHAN_HT20, 3942 NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS, 3943 NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS 3944 }; 3945 3946 /** 3947 * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions 3948 * 3949 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH 3950 * attribute. 3951 * 3952 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel 3953 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel 3954 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 3955 * attribute must be provided as well 3956 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 3957 * attribute must be provided as well 3958 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 3959 * and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well 3960 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 3961 * attribute must be provided as well 3962 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel 3963 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel 3964 */ 3965 enum nl80211_chan_width { 3966 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT, 3967 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 3968 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40, 3969 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80, 3970 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80, 3971 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160, 3972 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5, 3973 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10, 3974 }; 3975 3976 /** 3977 * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS 3978 * 3979 * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute. 3980 * 3981 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible 3982 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide 3983 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide 3984 */ 3985 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width { 3986 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 3987 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10, 3988 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5, 3989 }; 3990 3991 /** 3992 * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS 3993 * 3994 * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid 3995 * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets) 3996 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32) 3997 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64) 3998 * (if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be 3999 * from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon 4000 * that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from) 4001 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16) 4002 * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16) 4003 * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the 4004 * raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin); 4005 * if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is 4006 * different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise 4007 * they are from a Beacon frame. 4008 * However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these 4009 * IEs may be from either frame subtype. 4010 * If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the 4011 * data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics. 4012 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon 4013 * in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32) 4014 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon 4015 * in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8) 4016 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used" 4017 * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms 4018 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information 4019 * elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has 4020 * yet been received 4021 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel 4022 * (u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) 4023 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64) 4024 * (not present if no beacon frame has been received yet) 4025 * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and 4026 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute) 4027 * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry 4028 * was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be 4029 * accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds) 4030 * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 4031 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first 4032 * octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for 4033 * this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by 4034 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64). 4035 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF 4036 * is set. 4037 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update. 4038 * Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm), 4039 * using the nesting index as the antenna number. 4040 * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal 4041 * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute 4042 */ 4043 enum nl80211_bss { 4044 __NL80211_BSS_INVALID, 4045 NL80211_BSS_BSSID, 4046 NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY, 4047 NL80211_BSS_TSF, 4048 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL, 4049 NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY, 4050 NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS, 4051 NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM, 4052 NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 4053 NL80211_BSS_STATUS, 4054 NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO, 4055 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES, 4056 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH, 4057 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF, 4058 NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA, 4059 NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME, 4060 NL80211_BSS_PAD, 4061 NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF, 4062 NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID, 4063 NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL, 4064 4065 /* keep last */ 4066 __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST, 4067 NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1 4068 }; 4069 4070 /** 4071 * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status" 4072 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS. 4073 * Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer 4074 * keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with 4075 * a given BSS. 4076 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS. 4077 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS. 4078 * 4079 * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which 4080 * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS. 4081 */ 4082 enum nl80211_bss_status { 4083 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED, 4084 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED, 4085 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED, 4086 }; 4087 4088 /** 4089 * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType 4090 * 4091 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication 4092 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only) 4093 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r) 4094 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP) 4095 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals 4096 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key 4097 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS 4098 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key 4099 * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal 4100 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm 4101 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by 4102 * trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out 4103 * the attribute for this on CONNECT commands. 4104 */ 4105 enum nl80211_auth_type { 4106 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM, 4107 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY, 4108 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT, 4109 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP, 4110 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE, 4111 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK, 4112 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS, 4113 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK, 4114 4115 /* keep last */ 4116 __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM, 4117 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1, 4118 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC 4119 }; 4120 4121 /** 4122 * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type 4123 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key 4124 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key 4125 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS) 4126 * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types 4127 */ 4128 enum nl80211_key_type { 4129 NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP, 4130 NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE, 4131 NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY, 4132 4133 NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES 4134 }; 4135 4136 /** 4137 * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state 4138 * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used 4139 * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required 4140 * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional 4141 */ 4142 enum nl80211_mfp { 4143 NL80211_MFP_NO, 4144 NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED, 4145 NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL, 4146 }; 4147 4148 enum nl80211_wpa_versions { 4149 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0, 4150 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1, 4151 }; 4152 4153 /** 4154 * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types 4155 * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid 4156 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default 4157 * unicast key 4158 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default 4159 * multicast key 4160 * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types 4161 */ 4162 enum nl80211_key_default_types { 4163 __NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID, 4164 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST, 4165 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST, 4166 4167 NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES 4168 }; 4169 4170 /** 4171 * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes 4172 * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid 4173 * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of 4174 * 16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC 4175 * keys 4176 * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3) 4177 * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11 4178 * section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04) 4179 * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and 4180 * CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian 4181 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key 4182 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key 4183 * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not 4184 * specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was 4185 * given with the command using the key or not (u32) 4186 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags 4187 * attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as. 4188 * See &enum nl80211_key_default_types. 4189 * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal 4190 * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute 4191 */ 4192 enum nl80211_key_attributes { 4193 __NL80211_KEY_INVALID, 4194 NL80211_KEY_DATA, 4195 NL80211_KEY_IDX, 4196 NL80211_KEY_CIPHER, 4197 NL80211_KEY_SEQ, 4198 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT, 4199 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, 4200 NL80211_KEY_TYPE, 4201 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES, 4202 4203 /* keep last */ 4204 __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST, 4205 NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1 4206 }; 4207 4208 /** 4209 * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes 4210 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid 4211 * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection 4212 * in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with 4213 * 1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most 4214 * %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array). 4215 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection 4216 * in an array of MCS numbers. 4217 * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection, 4218 * see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht 4219 * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi 4220 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal 4221 * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute 4222 */ 4223 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes { 4224 __NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID, 4225 NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY, 4226 NL80211_TXRATE_HT, 4227 NL80211_TXRATE_VHT, 4228 NL80211_TXRATE_GI, 4229 4230 /* keep last */ 4231 __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST, 4232 NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1 4233 }; 4234 4235 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT 4236 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX 8 4237 4238 /** 4239 * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap 4240 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.) 4241 */ 4242 struct nl80211_txrate_vht { 4243 __u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 4244 }; 4245 4246 enum nl80211_txrate_gi { 4247 NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI, 4248 NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI, 4249 NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI, 4250 }; 4251 4252 /** 4253 * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band 4254 * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band 4255 * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz) 4256 * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 64.80 GHz) 4257 * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace 4258 * since newer kernel versions may support more bands 4259 */ 4260 enum nl80211_band { 4261 NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, 4262 NL80211_BAND_5GHZ, 4263 NL80211_BAND_60GHZ, 4264 4265 NUM_NL80211_BANDS, 4266 }; 4267 4268 /** 4269 * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state 4270 * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled 4271 * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled 4272 */ 4273 enum nl80211_ps_state { 4274 NL80211_PS_DISABLED, 4275 NL80211_PS_ENABLED, 4276 }; 4277 4278 /** 4279 * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes 4280 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid 4281 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies 4282 * the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero 4283 * to disable. Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is 4284 * set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of 4285 * threshold values in dBm. Events will be sent when the RSSI value 4286 * crosses any of the thresholds. 4287 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies 4288 * the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a 4289 * new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation). 4290 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event 4291 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many 4292 * consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer 4293 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures 4294 * during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an 4295 * %NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and 4296 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated. 4297 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given 4298 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is 4299 * checked. 4300 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic 4301 * interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and 4302 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an 4303 * %NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting. 4304 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon 4305 * loss event 4306 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the 4307 * RSSI threshold event. 4308 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal 4309 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute 4310 */ 4311 enum nl80211_attr_cqm { 4312 __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID, 4313 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD, 4314 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST, 4315 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT, 4316 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT, 4317 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE, 4318 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS, 4319 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL, 4320 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT, 4321 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL, 4322 4323 /* keep last */ 4324 __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST, 4325 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1 4326 }; 4327 4328 /** 4329 * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event 4330 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the 4331 * configured threshold 4332 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the 4333 * configured threshold 4334 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent) 4335 */ 4336 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event { 4337 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW, 4338 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH, 4339 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT, 4340 }; 4341 4342 4343 /** 4344 * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment 4345 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power 4346 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter 4347 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter 4348 */ 4349 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting { 4350 NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC, 4351 NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED, 4352 NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED, 4353 }; 4354 4355 /** 4356 * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute 4357 * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 4358 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has 4359 * a zero bit are ignored 4360 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have 4361 * a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds 4362 * to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are 4363 * in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern 4364 * corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask. 4365 * For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where 4366 * xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of 4367 * twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01". 4368 * Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not 4369 * 802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked 4370 * first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched. 4371 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after 4372 * these fixed number of bytes of received packet 4373 * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes 4374 * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number 4375 */ 4376 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr { 4377 __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID, 4378 NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK, 4379 NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN, 4380 NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET, 4381 4382 NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT, 4383 MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1, 4384 }; 4385 4386 /** 4387 * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information 4388 * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported 4389 * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern 4390 * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern 4391 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4392 * 4393 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when 4394 * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in 4395 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of 4396 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given 4397 * by the kernel to userspace. 4398 */ 4399 struct nl80211_pattern_support { 4400 __u32 max_patterns; 4401 __u32 min_pattern_len; 4402 __u32 max_pattern_len; 4403 __u32 max_pkt_offset; 4404 } __attribute__((packed)); 4405 4406 /* only for backward compatibility */ 4407 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID 4408 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK 4409 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN 4410 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET 4411 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT 4412 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT 4413 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support 4414 4415 /** 4416 * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions 4417 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 4418 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put 4419 * the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have 4420 * support for low-power operation already (flag) 4421 * Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if 4422 * any others are even supported by the device. 4423 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect 4424 * is detected is implementation-specific (flag) 4425 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed 4426 * by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag) 4427 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns 4428 * which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute 4429 * defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern. 4430 * Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with 4431 * each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is 4432 * done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the 4433 * pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU. 4434 * 4435 * In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute 4436 * carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support. 4437 * 4438 * When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based 4439 * index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed 4440 * to the kernel when configuring. 4441 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be 4442 * used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported 4443 * by the device (flag) 4444 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if 4445 * done by the device) (flag) 4446 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request 4447 * packet (flag) 4448 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag) 4449 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released 4450 * (on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag) 4451 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains 4452 * the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame 4453 * may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN 4454 * attribute contains the original length. 4455 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11 4456 * packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211 4457 * attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere. 4458 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the 4459 * 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may 4460 * be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute 4461 * contains the original length. 4462 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3 4463 * packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023 4464 * attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere. 4465 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section 4466 * "TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute 4467 * containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive 4468 * the TCP connection. 4469 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the 4470 * wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection 4471 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the 4472 * TCP connection was lost or failed to be established 4473 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only, 4474 * the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the 4475 * service 4476 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network 4477 * is detected. This is a nested attribute that contains the 4478 * same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN. It 4479 * specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the 4480 * channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan 4481 * results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets). This 4482 * attribute is also sent in a response to 4483 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets 4484 * supported by the driver (u32). 4485 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute 4486 * containing an array with information about what triggered the 4487 * wake up. If no elements are present in the array, it means 4488 * that the information is not available. If more than one 4489 * element is present, it means that more than one match 4490 * occurred. 4491 * Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains 4492 * one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional 4493 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute. At least one of 4494 * these attributes must be present. If 4495 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one 4496 * frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one 4497 * channel. 4498 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers 4499 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number 4500 * 4501 * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and 4502 * to report the wakeup reason(s). 4503 */ 4504 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers { 4505 __NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID, 4506 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY, 4507 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT, 4508 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT, 4509 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN, 4510 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED, 4511 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE, 4512 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST, 4513 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE, 4514 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE, 4515 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211, 4516 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN, 4517 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023, 4518 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN, 4519 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION, 4520 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH, 4521 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST, 4522 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS, 4523 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT, 4524 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS, 4525 4526 /* keep last */ 4527 NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG, 4528 MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1 4529 }; 4530 4531 /** 4532 * DOC: TCP connection wakeup 4533 * 4534 * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a 4535 * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If 4536 * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given 4537 * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data 4538 * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK. 4539 * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence 4540 * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also 4541 * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive 4542 * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc. 4543 * 4544 * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the 4545 * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern 4546 * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the 4547 * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is 4548 * also woken up. 4549 * 4550 * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP 4551 * response packets might not go through correctly. 4552 */ 4553 4554 /** 4555 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence 4556 * @start: starting value 4557 * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet 4558 * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4 4559 * 4560 * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the 4561 * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet 4562 * in little endian. 4563 */ 4564 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq { 4565 __u32 start, offset, len; 4566 }; 4567 4568 /** 4569 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config 4570 * @offset: offset of token in packet 4571 * @len: length of each token 4572 * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must 4573 * be a multiple of @len for this to make sense 4574 */ 4575 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token { 4576 __u32 offset, len; 4577 __u8 token_stream[]; 4578 }; 4579 4580 /** 4581 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features 4582 * @min_len: minimum token length 4583 * @max_len: maximum token length 4584 * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream) 4585 */ 4586 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature { 4587 __u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize; 4588 }; 4589 4590 /** 4591 * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters 4592 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 4593 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order) 4594 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address 4595 * (in network byte order) 4596 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because 4597 * route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend, 4598 * and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it 4599 * might require ARP querying. 4600 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a 4601 * socket and port will be allocated 4602 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16) 4603 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte. 4604 * For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length 4605 * of the data payload. 4606 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration 4607 * (if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature 4608 * advertising it is just a flag 4609 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration, 4610 * see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see 4611 * &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature. 4612 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum 4613 * interval in feature advertising (u32) 4614 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a 4615 * u32 attribute holding the maximum length 4616 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for 4617 * feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK 4618 * but on the TCP payload only. 4619 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes 4620 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number 4621 */ 4622 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs { 4623 __NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID, 4624 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4, 4625 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4, 4626 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC, 4627 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT, 4628 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT, 4629 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD, 4630 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ, 4631 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN, 4632 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL, 4633 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD, 4634 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK, 4635 4636 /* keep last */ 4637 NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP, 4638 MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1 4639 }; 4640 4641 /** 4642 * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information 4643 * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported 4644 * @pat: packet pattern support information 4645 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 4646 * 4647 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the 4648 * capability information given by the kernel to userspace. 4649 */ 4650 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support { 4651 __u32 max_rules; 4652 struct nl80211_pattern_support pat; 4653 __u32 max_delay; 4654 } __attribute__((packed)); 4655 4656 /** 4657 * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute 4658 * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 4659 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing 4660 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence, 4661 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 4662 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched 4663 * after these fixed number of bytes of received packet 4664 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes 4665 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number 4666 */ 4667 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule { 4668 __NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID, 4669 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY, 4670 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION, 4671 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN, 4672 4673 /* keep last */ 4674 NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE, 4675 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1 4676 }; 4677 4678 /** 4679 * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions 4680 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns 4681 * in a rule are matched. 4682 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns 4683 * in a rule are not matched. 4684 */ 4685 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition { 4686 NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH, 4687 NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH 4688 }; 4689 4690 /** 4691 * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes 4692 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved) 4693 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that 4694 * can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32) 4695 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a 4696 * flag attribute for each interface type in this set 4697 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes 4698 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number 4699 */ 4700 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs { 4701 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC, 4702 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX, 4703 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES, 4704 4705 /* keep last */ 4706 NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT, 4707 MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1 4708 }; 4709 4710 /** 4711 * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes 4712 * 4713 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved) 4714 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits 4715 * for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs. 4716 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of 4717 * interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't 4718 * apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed 4719 * in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE. 4720 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that 4721 * beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for 4722 * infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt 4723 * the infrastructure network's beacon interval. 4724 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many 4725 * different channels may be used within this group. 4726 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap 4727 * of supported channel widths for radar detection. 4728 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap 4729 * of supported regulatory regions for radar detection. 4730 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of 4731 * different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations 4732 * in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical). 4733 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes 4734 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number 4735 * 4736 * Examples: 4737 * limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2 4738 * => allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs 4739 * 4740 * numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8, 4741 * => allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd 4742 * 4743 * numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2 4744 * => allows two STAs on different channels 4745 * 4746 * numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4 4747 * => allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces 4748 * 4749 * The list of these four possiblities could completely be contained 4750 * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate 4751 * that any of these groups must match. 4752 * 4753 * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here, 4754 * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always 4755 * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid 4756 * interface type, the following group always exists: 4757 * numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1 4758 */ 4759 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs { 4760 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC, 4761 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS, 4762 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM, 4763 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH, 4764 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS, 4765 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS, 4766 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS, 4767 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD, 4768 4769 /* keep last */ 4770 NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB, 4771 MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1 4772 }; 4773 4774 4775 /** 4776 * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine 4777 * 4778 * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit 4779 * state of non existant mesh peer links 4780 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to 4781 * this mesh peer 4782 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received 4783 * from this mesh peer 4784 * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been 4785 * received from this mesh peer 4786 * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established 4787 * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled 4788 * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh 4789 * plink are discarded 4790 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states 4791 * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states 4792 */ 4793 enum nl80211_plink_state { 4794 NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN, 4795 NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT, 4796 NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD, 4797 NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD, 4798 NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB, 4799 NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING, 4800 NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED, 4801 4802 /* keep last */ 4803 NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES, 4804 MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1 4805 }; 4806 4807 /** 4808 * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers 4809 * 4810 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action 4811 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment 4812 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer 4813 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions 4814 */ 4815 enum plink_actions { 4816 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION, 4817 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN, 4818 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK, 4819 4820 NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS, 4821 }; 4822 4823 4824 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN 16 4825 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN 16 4826 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN 8 4827 4828 /** 4829 * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload 4830 * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 4831 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary) 4832 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary) 4833 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary) 4834 * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal) 4835 * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal) 4836 */ 4837 enum nl80211_rekey_data { 4838 __NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID, 4839 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK, 4840 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK, 4841 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR, 4842 4843 /* keep last */ 4844 NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA, 4845 MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1 4846 }; 4847 4848 /** 4849 * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID 4850 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in 4851 * Beacon frames) 4852 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element 4853 * in Beacon frames 4854 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID 4855 * element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID 4856 */ 4857 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid { 4858 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE, 4859 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN, 4860 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS 4861 }; 4862 4863 /** 4864 * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes 4865 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 4866 * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format 4867 * is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field. 4868 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same 4869 * as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down). 4870 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal 4871 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute 4872 */ 4873 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr { 4874 __NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID, 4875 NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES, 4876 NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP, 4877 4878 /* keep last */ 4879 __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST, 4880 NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1 4881 }; 4882 4883 /** 4884 * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates 4885 * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 4886 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher 4887 * priority) 4888 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets) 4889 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag) 4890 * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes 4891 * (internal) 4892 * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute 4893 * (internal) 4894 */ 4895 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr { 4896 __NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID, 4897 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX, 4898 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID, 4899 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH, 4900 4901 /* keep last */ 4902 NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 4903 MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1 4904 }; 4905 4906 /** 4907 * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION 4908 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request 4909 * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link 4910 * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established 4911 * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link 4912 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link 4913 */ 4914 enum nl80211_tdls_operation { 4915 NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ, 4916 NL80211_TDLS_SETUP, 4917 NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN, 4918 NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK, 4919 NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK, 4920 }; 4921 4922 /* 4923 * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features 4924 * Reserved for future use, no bits are defined in 4925 * NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME yet. 4926 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features { 4927 }; 4928 */ 4929 4930 /** 4931 * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features 4932 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back 4933 * TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the 4934 * socket option. 4935 * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates. 4936 * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up 4937 * the connected inactive stations in AP mode. 4938 * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested 4939 * to work properly to suppport receiving regulatory hints from 4940 * cellular base stations. 4941 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only 4942 * here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility) 4943 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of 4944 * equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station 4945 * mode 4946 * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan 4947 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported 4948 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif 4949 * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting 4950 * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform 4951 * OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only 4952 * for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied. 4953 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window 4954 * setting 4955 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic 4956 * powersave 4957 * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state 4958 * transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver 4959 * doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding 4960 * stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated 4961 * state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag 4962 * they should be added before even sending the authentication reply 4963 * and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized 4964 * states using station flags. 4965 * Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add 4966 * stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated 4967 * stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask. 4968 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits 4969 * (HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set 4970 * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh 4971 * Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for 4972 * beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is 4973 * still generated by the driver. 4974 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor 4975 * interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor 4976 * interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming 4977 * unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed. 4978 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic 4979 * channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the 4980 * lifetime of a BSS. 4981 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter 4982 * Set IE to probe requests. 4983 * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE 4984 * to probe requests. 4985 * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period 4986 * requests sent to it by an AP. 4987 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the 4988 * current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum 4989 * management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link 4990 * Measurement Report action frame. 4991 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout 4992 * estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used 4993 * to enable dynack. 4994 * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial 4995 * multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain 4996 * even on HT connections that should be using more chains. 4997 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial 4998 * multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain 4999 * and then wake the rest up as required after, for example, 5000 * rts/cts handshake. 5001 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM 5002 * TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS 5003 * command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it 5004 * needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things. 5005 * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring 5006 * the vif's MAC address upon creation. 5007 * See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h). 5008 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when 5009 * operating as a TDLS peer. 5010 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a 5011 * random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the 5012 * %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC 5013 * address mask/value will be used. 5014 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports 5015 * using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled 5016 * scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may 5017 * be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used. 5018 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a 5019 * random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e. 5020 * scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may 5021 * be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used. 5022 */ 5023 enum nl80211_feature_flags { 5024 NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS = 1 << 0, 5025 NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS = 1 << 1, 5026 NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER = 1 << 2, 5027 NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS = 1 << 3, 5028 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL = 1 << 4, 5029 NL80211_FEATURE_SAE = 1 << 5, 5030 NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN = 1 << 6, 5031 NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH = 1 << 7, 5032 NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN = 1 << 8, 5033 NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER = 1 << 9, 5034 NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN = 1 << 10, 5035 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN = 1 << 11, 5036 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS = 1 << 12, 5037 /* bit 13 is reserved */ 5038 NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS = 1 << 14, 5039 NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE = 1 << 15, 5040 NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM = 1 << 16, 5041 NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR = 1 << 17, 5042 NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE = 1 << 18, 5043 NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES = 1 << 19, 5044 NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES = 1 << 20, 5045 NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET = 1 << 21, 5046 NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION = 1 << 22, 5047 NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION = 1 << 23, 5048 NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS = 1 << 24, 5049 NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS = 1 << 25, 5050 NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION = 1 << 26, 5051 NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE = 1 << 27, 5052 NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = 1 << 28, 5053 NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 29, 5054 NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 30, 5055 NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 31, 5056 }; 5057 5058 /** 5059 * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features. 5060 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates. 5061 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can 5062 * can request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with 5063 * %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set 5064 * the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if 5065 * NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized. 5066 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air 5067 * sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from 5068 * certain groups which can be configured by the 5069 * %NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute, 5070 * or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the 5071 * %NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute. 5072 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual 5073 * time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of 5074 * the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to 5075 * (if available). 5076 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the 5077 * time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the 5078 * BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to 5079 * (if available). 5080 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of 5081 * channel dwell time. 5082 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate 5083 * configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate. 5084 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate 5085 * configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates. 5086 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate 5087 * configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates. 5088 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup 5089 * with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode. 5090 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA 5091 * in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated. 5092 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports 5093 * randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated. 5094 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan 5095 * for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS 5096 * (%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI). 5097 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the 5098 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more 5099 * RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold. 5100 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key 5101 * authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 5102 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way 5103 * handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect 5104 * and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported. 5105 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way 5106 * handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host 5107 * and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not 5108 * be supported. 5109 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding 5110 * the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the 5111 * actual dwell time. 5112 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe 5113 * response 5114 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending 5115 * the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps. 5116 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports 5117 * probe request tx deferral and suppression 5118 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL 5119 * value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP. 5120 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan. 5121 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan. 5122 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan. 5123 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions. 5124 * Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself, 5125 * informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event, 5126 * channel change triggered by radar detection event. 5127 * No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to 5128 * "radar detected" event. 5129 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and 5130 * receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice. 5131 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This Driver support data ack 5132 * rssi if firmware support, this flag is to intimate about ack rssi 5133 * support to nl80211. 5134 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate 5135 * TXQs. 5136 * 5137 * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features. 5138 * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index. 5139 */ 5140 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index { 5141 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS, 5142 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM, 5143 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER, 5144 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME, 5145 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF, 5146 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL, 5147 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY, 5148 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT, 5149 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT, 5150 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA, 5151 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA, 5152 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED, 5153 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI, 5154 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST, 5155 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD, 5156 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK, 5157 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X, 5158 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME, 5159 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 5160 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE, 5161 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION, 5162 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL, 5163 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN, 5164 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN, 5165 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN, 5166 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD, 5167 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, 5168 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT, 5169 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS, 5170 5171 /* add new features before the definition below */ 5172 NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 5173 MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1 5174 }; 5175 5176 /** 5177 * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported 5178 * protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW. 5179 * To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute. 5180 * Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported 5181 * protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a 5182 * supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded 5183 * to the host. 5184 * 5185 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1 5186 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2 5187 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P 5188 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u 5189 */ 5190 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr { 5191 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS = 1<<0, 5192 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 = 1<<1, 5193 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P = 1<<2, 5194 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U = 1<<3, 5195 }; 5196 5197 /** 5198 * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons 5199 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be 5200 * handled by the AP is reached. 5201 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL. 5202 */ 5203 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason { 5204 NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS, 5205 NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT, 5206 }; 5207 5208 /** 5209 * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons 5210 * 5211 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified. 5212 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out. 5213 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out. 5214 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out. 5215 */ 5216 enum nl80211_timeout_reason { 5217 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED, 5218 NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN, 5219 NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH, 5220 NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC, 5221 }; 5222 5223 /** 5224 * enum nl80211_scan_flags - scan request control flags 5225 * 5226 * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling 5227 * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN 5228 * requests. 5229 * 5230 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and 5231 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only 5232 * one of them can be used in the request. 5233 * 5234 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority 5235 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning 5236 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured 5237 * as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is 5238 * dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames 5239 * will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only 5240 * when really needed 5241 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or 5242 * for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the 5243 * flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and 5244 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only 5245 * the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder 5246 * randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits, 5247 * locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed. 5248 * This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check 5249 * the nl80211 feature flags for the device. 5250 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS 5251 * request parameters IE in the probe request 5252 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses 5253 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at 5254 * rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is dicovered in the channel, 5255 * only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate. 5256 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request 5257 * tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms) 5258 * and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame, 5259 * Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers 5260 * a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of 5261 * SSID and/or RSSI. 5262 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to 5263 * accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the 5264 * scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver 5265 * implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get 5266 * impacted with this flag. 5267 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume 5268 * optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to 5269 * optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag. 5270 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan 5271 * results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum 5272 * possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best 5273 * possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning. 5274 * Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag. 5275 */ 5276 enum nl80211_scan_flags { 5277 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY = 1<<0, 5278 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH = 1<<1, 5279 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP = 1<<2, 5280 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR = 1<<3, 5281 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME = 1<<4, 5282 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<5, 5283 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE = 1<<6, 5284 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION = 1<<7, 5285 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN = 1<<8, 5286 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER = 1<<9, 5287 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY = 1<<10, 5288 }; 5289 5290 /** 5291 * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy 5292 * 5293 * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by 5294 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to 5295 * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. 5296 * 5297 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are 5298 * listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed 5299 * in ACL to authenticate. 5300 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed 5301 * in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL. 5302 */ 5303 enum nl80211_acl_policy { 5304 NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED, 5305 NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED, 5306 }; 5307 5308 /** 5309 * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode 5310 * 5311 * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode) 5312 * 5313 * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas). 5314 * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna) 5315 * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and 5316 * turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS). 5317 */ 5318 enum nl80211_smps_mode { 5319 NL80211_SMPS_OFF, 5320 NL80211_SMPS_STATIC, 5321 NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 5322 5323 __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST, 5324 NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1 5325 }; 5326 5327 /** 5328 * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation 5329 * 5330 * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace 5331 * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC) 5332 * 5333 * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is 5334 * now unusable. 5335 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished, 5336 * the channel is now available. 5337 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no 5338 * change to the channel status. 5339 * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is 5340 * over, channel becomes usable. 5341 * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this 5342 * non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must 5343 * be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not 5344 * applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever. 5345 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started, 5346 * should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled. 5347 */ 5348 enum nl80211_radar_event { 5349 NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED, 5350 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED, 5351 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED, 5352 NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED, 5353 NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED, 5354 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED, 5355 }; 5356 5357 /** 5358 * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels 5359 * 5360 * Channel states used by the DFS code. 5361 * 5362 * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability 5363 * check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS. 5364 * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it 5365 * is therefore marked as not available. 5366 * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available. 5367 */ 5368 enum nl80211_dfs_state { 5369 NL80211_DFS_USABLE, 5370 NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE, 5371 NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE, 5372 }; 5373 5374 /** 5375 * enum enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features 5376 * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting 5377 * wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute 5378 * %NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the 5379 * wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or 5380 * %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV. 5381 */ 5382 enum nl80211_protocol_features { 5383 NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP = 1 << 0, 5384 }; 5385 5386 /** 5387 * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers 5388 * 5389 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified. 5390 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol. 5391 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol. 5392 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol. 5393 * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last. 5394 */ 5395 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id { 5396 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC, 5397 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP, 5398 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL, 5399 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA, 5400 /* add other protocols before this one */ 5401 NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO 5402 }; 5403 5404 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */ 5405 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION 5000 /* msec */ 5406 5407 /** 5408 * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame. 5409 * 5410 * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt() 5411 * 5412 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver. 5413 */ 5414 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags { 5415 NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0, 5416 }; 5417 5418 /* 5419 * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set 5420 * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated 5421 * yet, so that's not valid so far) 5422 */ 5423 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX 0x80000000 5424 5425 /** 5426 * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data 5427 * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the 5428 * value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID 5429 * may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be 5430 * added to this file when needed. 5431 * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command 5432 */ 5433 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info { 5434 __u32 vendor_id; 5435 __u32 subcmd; 5436 }; 5437 5438 /** 5439 * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags. 5440 * 5441 * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need 5442 * to be added to TDLS Setup frames. 5443 * 5444 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable. 5445 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable. 5446 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable. 5447 */ 5448 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability { 5449 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0, 5450 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1, 5451 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2, 5452 }; 5453 5454 /** 5455 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan 5456 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 5457 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In 5458 * seconds (u32). 5459 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this 5460 * scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute 5461 * because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will 5462 * make the scan plan meaningless. 5463 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number 5464 * currently defined 5465 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use 5466 */ 5467 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan { 5468 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID, 5469 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL, 5470 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS, 5471 5472 /* keep last */ 5473 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST, 5474 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX = 5475 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1 5476 }; 5477 5478 /** 5479 * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters. 5480 * 5481 * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value 5482 * of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band. 5483 * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB. 5484 */ 5485 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust { 5486 __u8 band; 5487 __s8 delta; 5488 } __attribute__((packed)); 5489 5490 /** 5491 * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection. 5492 * 5493 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved. 5494 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection 5495 * is requested. 5496 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS 5497 * selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred. 5498 * When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver 5499 * shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of 5500 * this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32). 5501 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for 5502 * BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 5503 * RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure 5504 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 5505 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number. 5506 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use. 5507 * 5508 * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT 5509 * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour 5510 * which the driver shall use. 5511 */ 5512 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr { 5513 __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID, 5514 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI, 5515 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF, 5516 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST, 5517 5518 /* keep last */ 5519 __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 5520 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 5521 }; 5522 5523 /** 5524 * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type 5525 * 5526 * Defines the function type of a NAN function 5527 * 5528 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish 5529 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe 5530 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up 5531 */ 5532 enum nl80211_nan_function_type { 5533 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, 5534 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE, 5535 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, 5536 5537 /* keep last */ 5538 __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST, 5539 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1, 5540 }; 5541 5542 /** 5543 * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type 5544 * 5545 * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames 5546 * 5547 * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited 5548 * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited 5549 */ 5550 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type { 5551 NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0, 5552 NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1, 5553 }; 5554 5555 /** 5556 * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason 5557 * 5558 * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function 5559 * 5560 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user 5561 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout 5562 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored 5563 */ 5564 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason { 5565 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST, 5566 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED, 5567 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR, 5568 }; 5569 5570 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6 5571 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff 5572 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff 5573 5574 /** 5575 * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes 5576 * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid 5577 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8). 5578 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as 5579 * specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute. 5580 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is 5581 * publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery 5582 * Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8. 5583 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited 5584 * publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to 5585 * the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag. 5586 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is 5587 * subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag. 5588 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up. 5589 * The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8. 5590 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type 5591 * is follow up. This is a u8. 5592 * The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. 5593 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the 5594 * follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute. 5595 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a 5596 * close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device. 5597 * This is a flag. 5598 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should 5599 * stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32. 5600 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service 5601 * specific info. This is a binary attribute. 5602 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute. 5603 * See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes. 5604 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested 5605 * attribute. It is a list of binary values. 5606 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a 5607 * nested attribute. It is a list of binary values. 5608 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function. 5609 * Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0. 5610 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason. 5611 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason. 5612 * 5613 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal 5614 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute 5615 */ 5616 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes { 5617 __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID, 5618 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE, 5619 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID, 5620 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE, 5621 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST, 5622 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE, 5623 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID, 5624 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID, 5625 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST, 5626 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE, 5627 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL, 5628 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO, 5629 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF, 5630 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER, 5631 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER, 5632 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID, 5633 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON, 5634 5635 /* keep last */ 5636 NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR, 5637 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1 5638 }; 5639 5640 /** 5641 * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes 5642 * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid 5643 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set. 5644 * This is a flag. 5645 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if 5646 * %NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary. 5647 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if 5648 * %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8. 5649 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if 5650 * and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested 5651 * attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address. 5652 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal 5653 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute 5654 */ 5655 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes { 5656 __NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID, 5657 NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE, 5658 NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF, 5659 NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX, 5660 NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS, 5661 5662 /* keep last */ 5663 NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR, 5664 NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1, 5665 }; 5666 5667 /** 5668 * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes 5669 * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid 5670 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the 5671 * match. This is a nested attribute. 5672 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes. 5673 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function 5674 * that caused the match. This is a nested attribute. 5675 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes. 5676 * 5677 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal 5678 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute 5679 */ 5680 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes { 5681 __NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID, 5682 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL, 5683 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER, 5684 5685 /* keep last */ 5686 NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR, 5687 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1 5688 }; 5689 5690 /** 5691 * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external 5692 * authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION. 5693 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication. 5694 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication. 5695 */ 5696 enum nl80211_external_auth_action { 5697 NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START, 5698 NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT, 5699 }; 5700 5701 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */ 5702